* gdb.texinfo (How Overlays Work): Shrink the overlay diagram.
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @set EDITION Ninth
32
33 @c !!set GDB manual's revision date
34 @set DATE December 2001
35
36 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
37
38 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
39 @c manuals to an info tree.
40 @dircategory Programming & development tools.
41 @direntry
42 * Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
43 @end direntry
44
45 @ifinfo
46 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
47
48
49 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
50 of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
51 for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
52
53 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
54 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
55
56 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
57 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
58 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
59 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
60 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
61 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
62
63 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
64 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
65 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
66 development.''
67 @end ifinfo
68
69 @titlepage
70 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
71 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
72 @sp 1
73 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
74 @subtitle @value{DATE}
75 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76 @page
77 @tex
78 {\parskip=0pt
79 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82 }
83 @end tex
84
85 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
87 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
88 @sp 2
89 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
90 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
91 Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
92 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
93
94 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
95 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
96 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
97 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
98 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
99 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
100
101 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
102 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
103 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
104 development.''
105 @end titlepage
106 @page
107
108 @ifnottex
109 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
110
111 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
112
113 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
114
115 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
116 @value{GDBVN}.
117
118 Copyright (C) 1988-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
119
120 @menu
121 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
122 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
123
124 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
125 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
126 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
127 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
128 * Stack:: Examining the stack
129 * Source:: Examining source files
130 * Data:: Examining data
131 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
132 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
133
134 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
135
136 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
137 * Altering:: Altering execution
138 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
139 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
140 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
141 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
142 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
143 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
144 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
145 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
146 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
147 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
148
149 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
150 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
151
152 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
153 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
154 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
155 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
156 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
157 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
158 * Index:: Index
159 @end menu
160
161 @end ifnottex
162
163 @contents
164
165 @node Summary
166 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
167
168 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
169 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
170 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
171
172 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
173 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
174
175 @itemize @bullet
176 @item
177 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
178
179 @item
180 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
181
182 @item
183 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
184
185 @item
186 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
187 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
188 @end itemize
189
190 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
191 For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
192 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
193
194 @cindex Chill
195 @cindex Modula-2
196 Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
197 see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
198
199 @cindex Pascal
200 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
201 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
202 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
203 syntax.
204
205 @cindex Fortran
206 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
207 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
208 underscore.
209
210 @menu
211 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
212 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
213 @end menu
214
215 @node Free Software
216 @unnumberedsec Free software
217
218 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
219 General Public License
220 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
221 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
222 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
223 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
224 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
225 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
226
227 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
228 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
229 from anyone else.
230
231 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
232
233 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
234 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
235 include with the free software. Many of our most important
236 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
237 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
238 when an important free software package does not come with a free
239 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
240 gaps today.
241
242 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
243 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
244 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
245 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
246 them from the free software world.
247
248 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
249 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
250 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
251 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
252 contract to make it non-free.
253
254 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
255 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
256 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
257 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
258 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
259 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
260 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
261
262 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
263 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
264 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
265 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
266
267 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
268 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
269 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
270 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
271 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
272 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
273 community.
274
275 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
276 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
277 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
278 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
279 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
280 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
281 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
282 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
283 of the manual.
284
285 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
286 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
287 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
288 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
289 manual to replace it.
290
291 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
292 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
293 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
294 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
295 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
296 the free software community.
297
298 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
299 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
300 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
301 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
302 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
303 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
304 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
305 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
306 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
307
308 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
309 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
310 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
311 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
312 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
313 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
314 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
315 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
316
317 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
318 published by other publishers, at
319 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
320
321 @node Contributors
322 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
323
324 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
325 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
326 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
327 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
328 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
329 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
330 blow-by-blow account.
331
332 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
333
334 @quotation
335 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
336 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
337 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
338 @end quotation
339
340 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
341 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
342 releases:
343 Andrew Cagney (releases 5.0 and 5.1);
344 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
345 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
346 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
347 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
348 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
349 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
350 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
351 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
352
353 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
354 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
355
356 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
357 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
358 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
359 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
360 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
361
362 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
363 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
364 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
365
366 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
367 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
368
369 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
370
371 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
372 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
373 support.
374 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
375 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
376 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
377 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
378 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
379 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
380 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
381 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
382 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
383 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
384 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
385 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
386 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
387 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
388 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
389
390 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
391
392 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
393 libraries.
394
395 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
396 about several machine instruction sets.
397
398 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
399 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
400 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
401 and RDI targets, respectively.
402
403 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
404 command-line editing and command history.
405
406 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
407 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
408
409 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
410 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
411 symbols.
412
413 Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
414 Super-H processors.
415
416 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
417
418 Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
419
420 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
421
422 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
423
424 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
425
426 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
427 watchpoints.
428
429 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
430
431 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
432
433 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
434 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
435
436 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
437 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
438 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
439 compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
440 John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
441 Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
442 information in this manual.
443
444 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
445 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
446
447 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
448 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
449 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
450 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
451 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
452 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
453 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
454 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
455 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
456 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
457 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
458 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
459 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
460 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
461 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
462
463
464 @node Sample Session
465 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
466
467 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
468 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
469 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
470
471 @iftex
472 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
473 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
474 @end iftex
475
476 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
477 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
478
479 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
480 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
481 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
482 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
483 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
484 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
485 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
486 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
487 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
488
489 @smallexample
490 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
491 $ @b{./m4}
492 @b{define(foo,0000)}
493
494 @b{foo}
495 0000
496 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
497
498 @b{bar}
499 0000
500 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
501
502 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
503 @b{baz}
504 @b{C-d}
505 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
506 @end smallexample
507
508 @noindent
509 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
510
511 @smallexample
512 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
513 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
514 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
515 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
516 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
517 the conditions.
518 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
519 for details.
520
521 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
522 (@value{GDBP})
523 @end smallexample
524
525 @noindent
526 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
527 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
528 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
529 that examples fit in this manual.
530
531 @smallexample
532 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
533 @end smallexample
534
535 @noindent
536 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
537 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
538 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
539 @code{break} command.
540
541 @smallexample
542 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
543 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
544 @end smallexample
545
546 @noindent
547 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
548 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
549 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
550
551 @smallexample
552 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
553 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
554 @b{define(foo,0000)}
555
556 @b{foo}
557 0000
558 @end smallexample
559
560 @noindent
561 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
562 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
563 context where it stops.
564
565 @smallexample
566 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
567
568 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
569 at builtin.c:879
570 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
571 @end smallexample
572
573 @noindent
574 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
575 the next line of the current function.
576
577 @smallexample
578 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
579 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
580 : nil,
581 @end smallexample
582
583 @noindent
584 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
585 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
586 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
587 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
588
589 @smallexample
590 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
591 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
592 at input.c:530
593 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
594 @end smallexample
595
596 @noindent
597 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
598 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
599 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
600 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
601 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
602 stack frame for each active subroutine.
603
604 @smallexample
605 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
606 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
607 at input.c:530
608 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
609 at builtin.c:882
610 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
611 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
612 at macro.c:71
613 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
614 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
615 @end smallexample
616
617 @noindent
618 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
619 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
620 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
621
622 @smallexample
623 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
624 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
625 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
626 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
627 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
629 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
630 : xstrdup(rq);
631 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
632 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
633 @end smallexample
634
635 @noindent
636 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
637 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
638 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
639 (@code{print}) to see their values.
640
641 @smallexample
642 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
643 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
644 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
645 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
646 @end smallexample
647
648 @noindent
649 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
650 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
651 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
652
653 @smallexample
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
655 533 xfree(rquote);
656 534
657 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
658 : xstrdup (lq);
659 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
660 : xstrdup (rq);
661 537
662 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
663 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
664 540 @}
665 541
666 542 void
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
671 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
672
673 @smallexample
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
676 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
677 540 @}
678 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
679 $3 = 9
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
681 $4 = 7
682 @end smallexample
683
684 @noindent
685 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
686 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
687 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
688 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
689 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
690 assignments.
691
692 @smallexample
693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
694 $5 = 7
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
696 $6 = 9
697 @end smallexample
698
699 @noindent
700 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
701 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
702 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
703 example that caused trouble initially:
704
705 @smallexample
706 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
707 Continuing.
708
709 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
710
711 baz
712 0000
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
717 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
718 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
719
720 @smallexample
721 @b{C-d}
722 Program exited normally.
723 @end smallexample
724
725 @noindent
726 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
727 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
728 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
729
730 @smallexample
731 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
732 @end smallexample
733
734 @node Invocation
735 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
736
737 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
738 The essentials are:
739 @itemize @bullet
740 @item
741 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
742 @item
743 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
744 @end itemize
745
746 @menu
747 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
748 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
749 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
750 @end menu
751
752 @node Invoking GDB
753 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
754
755 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
756 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
757
758 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
759 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
760
761 The command-line options described here are designed
762 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
763 options may effectively be unavailable.
764
765 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
766 specifying an executable program:
767
768 @example
769 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
770 @end example
771
772 @noindent
773 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
774 specified:
775
776 @example
777 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
778 @end example
779
780 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
781 to debug a running process:
782
783 @example
784 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
785 @end example
786
787 @noindent
788 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
789 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
790
791 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
792 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
793 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
794 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
795 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
796
797 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
798 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
799 option processing.
800 @example
801 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
802 @end example
803 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
804 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
805
806 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
807 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
808
809 @smallexample
810 @value{GDBP} -silent
811 @end smallexample
812
813 @noindent
814 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
815 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
816
817 @noindent
818 Type
819
820 @example
821 @value{GDBP} -help
822 @end example
823
824 @noindent
825 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
826 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
827
828 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
829 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
830 @samp{-x} option is used.
831
832
833 @menu
834 * File Options:: Choosing files
835 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
836 @end menu
837
838 @node File Options
839 @subsection Choosing files
840
841 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
842 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
843 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
844 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
845 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
846 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
847 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
848 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
849 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
850 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
851 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
852 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
853 prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
854
855 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
856 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
857 argument and ignore it.
858
859 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
860 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
861 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
862 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
863 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
864
865 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
866 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
867 @c it.
868
869 @table @code
870 @item -symbols @var{file}
871 @itemx -s @var{file}
872 @cindex @code{--symbols}
873 @cindex @code{-s}
874 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
875
876 @item -exec @var{file}
877 @itemx -e @var{file}
878 @cindex @code{--exec}
879 @cindex @code{-e}
880 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
881 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
882
883 @item -se @var{file}
884 @cindex @code{--se}
885 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
886 file.
887
888 @item -core @var{file}
889 @itemx -c @var{file}
890 @cindex @code{--core}
891 @cindex @code{-c}
892 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
893
894 @item -c @var{number}
895 @item -pid @var{number}
896 @itemx -p @var{number}
897 @cindex @code{--pid}
898 @cindex @code{-p}
899 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
900 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
901 file named @var{number}.
902
903 @item -command @var{file}
904 @itemx -x @var{file}
905 @cindex @code{--command}
906 @cindex @code{-x}
907 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
908 Files,, Command files}.
909
910 @item -directory @var{directory}
911 @itemx -d @var{directory}
912 @cindex @code{--directory}
913 @cindex @code{-d}
914 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
915
916 @item -m
917 @itemx -mapped
918 @cindex @code{--mapped}
919 @cindex @code{-m}
920 @emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
921 supported on all systems.}@*
922 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
923 system call, you can use this option
924 to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
925 program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
926 called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
927 Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
928 and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
929 the symbol table from the executable program.
930
931 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
932 is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
933 table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
934
935 @item -r
936 @itemx -readnow
937 @cindex @code{--readnow}
938 @cindex @code{-r}
939 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
940 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
941 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
942
943 @end table
944
945 You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
946 order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
947 information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
948 on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
949 but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
950
951 @example
952 gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
953 @end example
954
955 @node Mode Options
956 @subsection Choosing modes
957
958 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
959 batch mode or quiet mode.
960
961 @table @code
962 @item -nx
963 @itemx -n
964 @cindex @code{--nx}
965 @cindex @code{-n}
966 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
967 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
968 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
969 files}.
970
971 @item -quiet
972 @itemx -silent
973 @itemx -q
974 @cindex @code{--quiet}
975 @cindex @code{--silent}
976 @cindex @code{-q}
977 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
978 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
979
980 @item -batch
981 @cindex @code{--batch}
982 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
983 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
984 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
985 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
986 in the command files.
987
988 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
989 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
990 make this more useful, the message
991
992 @example
993 Program exited normally.
994 @end example
995
996 @noindent
997 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
998 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
999 mode.
1000
1001 @item -nowindows
1002 @itemx -nw
1003 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1004 @cindex @code{-nw}
1005 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1006 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1007 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1008
1009 @item -windows
1010 @itemx -w
1011 @cindex @code{--windows}
1012 @cindex @code{-w}
1013 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1014 used if possible.
1015
1016 @item -cd @var{directory}
1017 @cindex @code{--cd}
1018 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1019 instead of the current directory.
1020
1021 @item -fullname
1022 @itemx -f
1023 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1024 @cindex @code{-f}
1025 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1026 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1027 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1028 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1029 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1030 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1031 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1032 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1033 frame.
1034
1035 @item -epoch
1036 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1037 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1038 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1039 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1040 separate window.
1041
1042 @item -annotate @var{level}
1043 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1044 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1045 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1046 (@pxref{Annotations}).
1047 Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1048 together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1049 types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1050 @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1051 maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1052
1053 @item -async
1054 @cindex @code{--async}
1055 Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1056 @value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1057 special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1058 commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1059 run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1060 MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1061 suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1062 control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1063 (@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
1064 operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1065 yet.)
1066 @c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1067 @c should be removed.
1068
1069 When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1070 uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1071 @samp{-noasync} option.
1072
1073 @item -noasync
1074 @cindex @code{--noasync}
1075 Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1076
1077 @item --args
1078 @cindex @code{--args}
1079 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1080 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1081 This option stops option processing.
1082
1083 @item -baud @var{bps}
1084 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1085 @cindex @code{--baud}
1086 @cindex @code{-b}
1087 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1088 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1089
1090 @item -tty @var{device}
1091 @itemx -t @var{device}
1092 @cindex @code{--tty}
1093 @cindex @code{-t}
1094 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1095 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1096
1097 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1098 @item -tui
1099 @cindex @code{--tui}
1100 Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1101 The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1102 showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1103 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1104 Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1105 (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1106
1107 @c @item -xdb
1108 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1109 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1110 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1111 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1112 @c systems.
1113
1114 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1115 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1116 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1117 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1118 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1119
1120 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi1}) causes
1121 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdb/mi interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The
1122 @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The older @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in
1123 @value{GDBN} version 5.0 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi0}.
1124
1125 @item -write
1126 @cindex @code{--write}
1127 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1128 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1129 (@pxref{Patching}).
1130
1131 @item -statistics
1132 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1133 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1134 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1135
1136 @item -version
1137 @cindex @code{--version}
1138 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1139 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1140
1141 @end table
1142
1143 @node Quitting GDB
1144 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1145 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1146 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1147
1148 @table @code
1149 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1150 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1151 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1152 @itemx q
1153 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1154 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1155 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1156 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1157 error code.
1158 @end table
1159
1160 @cindex interrupt
1161 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1162 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1163 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1164 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1165 until a time when it is safe.
1166
1167 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1168 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1169 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1170
1171 @node Shell Commands
1172 @section Shell commands
1173
1174 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1175 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1176 just use the @code{shell} command.
1177
1178 @table @code
1179 @kindex shell
1180 @cindex shell escape
1181 @item shell @var{command string}
1182 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1183 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1184 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1185 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1186 @end table
1187
1188 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1189 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1190 @value{GDBN}:
1191
1192 @table @code
1193 @kindex make
1194 @cindex calling make
1195 @item make @var{make-args}
1196 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1197 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1198 @end table
1199
1200 @node Commands
1201 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1202
1203 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1204 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1205 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1206 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1207 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1208
1209 @menu
1210 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1211 * Completion:: Command completion
1212 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1213 @end menu
1214
1215 @node Command Syntax
1216 @section Command syntax
1217
1218 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1219 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1220 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1221 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1222 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1223 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1224
1225 @cindex abbreviation
1226 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1227 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1228 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1229 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1230 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1231 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1232 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1233
1234 @cindex repeating commands
1235 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1236 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1237 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1238 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1239 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1240 repeat.
1241
1242 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1243 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1244 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1245
1246 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1247 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1248 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1249 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1250 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1251
1252 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1253 @cindex comment
1254 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1255 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1256 Files,,Command files}).
1257
1258 @cindex repeating command sequences
1259 @kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1260 The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1261 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1262 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1263 for editing.
1264
1265 @node Completion
1266 @section Command completion
1267
1268 @cindex completion
1269 @cindex word completion
1270 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1271 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1272 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1273 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1274
1275 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1276 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1277 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1278 enter it). For example, if you type
1279
1280 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1281 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1282 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1283 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1284 @example
1285 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1286 @end example
1287
1288 @noindent
1289 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1290 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1291
1292 @example
1293 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1294 @end example
1295
1296 @noindent
1297 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1298 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1299 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1300 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1301 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1302 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1303
1304 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1305 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1306 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1307 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1308 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1309 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1310 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1311 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1312 example:
1313
1314 @example
1315 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1316 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1317 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1318 make_abs_section make_function_type
1319 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1320 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1321 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1322 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1323 @end example
1324
1325 @noindent
1326 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1327 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1328 command.
1329
1330 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1331 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1332 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1333 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1334 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1335
1336 @cindex quotes in commands
1337 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1338 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1339 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1340 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1341 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1342 @value{GDBN} commands.
1343
1344 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1345 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1346 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1347 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1348 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1349 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1350 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1351 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1352 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1353 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1354 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1355
1356 @example
1357 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1358 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1359 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1360 @end example
1361
1362 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1363 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1364 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1365 place:
1366
1367 @example
1368 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1369 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1370 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1371 @end example
1372
1373 @noindent
1374 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1375 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1376 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1377
1378 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1379 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1380 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1381 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1382
1383
1384 @node Help
1385 @section Getting help
1386 @cindex online documentation
1387 @kindex help
1388
1389 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1390 using the command @code{help}.
1391
1392 @table @code
1393 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1394 @item help
1395 @itemx h
1396 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1397 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1398
1399 @smallexample
1400 (@value{GDBP}) help
1401 List of classes of commands:
1402
1403 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1404 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1405 data -- Examining data
1406 files -- Specifying and examining files
1407 internals -- Maintenance commands
1408 obscure -- Obscure features
1409 running -- Running the program
1410 stack -- Examining the stack
1411 status -- Status inquiries
1412 support -- Support facilities
1413 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1414 stopping the program
1415 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1416
1417 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1418 commands in that class.
1419 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1420 documentation.
1421 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1422 (@value{GDBP})
1423 @end smallexample
1424 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1425
1426 @item help @var{class}
1427 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1428 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1429 help display for the class @code{status}:
1430
1431 @smallexample
1432 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1433 Status inquiries.
1434
1435 List of commands:
1436
1437 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1438 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1439 info -- Generic command for showing things
1440 about the program being debugged
1441 show -- Generic command for showing things
1442 about the debugger
1443
1444 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1445 documentation.
1446 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1447 (@value{GDBP})
1448 @end smallexample
1449
1450 @item help @var{command}
1451 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1452 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1453
1454 @kindex apropos
1455 @item apropos @var{args}
1456 The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1457 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1458 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1459
1460 @smallexample
1461 apropos reload
1462 @end smallexample
1463
1464 @noindent
1465 results in:
1466
1467 @smallexample
1468 @c @group
1469 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1470 multiple times in one run
1471 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1472 multiple times in one run
1473 @c @end group
1474 @end smallexample
1475
1476 @kindex complete
1477 @item complete @var{args}
1478 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1479 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1480 command you want completed. For example:
1481
1482 @smallexample
1483 complete i
1484 @end smallexample
1485
1486 @noindent results in:
1487
1488 @smallexample
1489 @group
1490 if
1491 ignore
1492 info
1493 inspect
1494 @end group
1495 @end smallexample
1496
1497 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1498 @end table
1499
1500 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1501 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1502 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1503 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1504 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1505 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1506
1507 @c @group
1508 @table @code
1509 @kindex info
1510 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1511 @item info
1512 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1513 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1514 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1515 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1516 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1517 @w{@code{help info}}.
1518
1519 @kindex set
1520 @item set
1521 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1522 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1523 @code{set prompt $}.
1524
1525 @kindex show
1526 @item show
1527 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1528 @value{GDBN} itself.
1529 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1530 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1531 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1532 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1533
1534 @kindex info set
1535 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1536 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1537 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1538 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1539 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1540 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1541 @end table
1542 @c @end group
1543
1544 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1545 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1546
1547 @table @code
1548 @kindex show version
1549 @cindex version number
1550 @item show version
1551 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1552 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1553 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1554 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1555 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1556 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1557 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1558 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1559 @value{GDBN}.
1560
1561 @kindex show copying
1562 @item show copying
1563 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1564
1565 @kindex show warranty
1566 @item show warranty
1567 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1568 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1569
1570 @end table
1571
1572 @node Running
1573 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1574
1575 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1576 debugging information when you compile it.
1577
1578 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1579 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1580 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1581 kill a child process.
1582
1583 @menu
1584 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1585 * Starting:: Starting your program
1586 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1587 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1588
1589 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1590 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1591 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1592 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1593
1594 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1595 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1596 @end menu
1597
1598 @node Compilation
1599 @section Compiling for debugging
1600
1601 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1602 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1603 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1604 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1605 and addresses in the executable code.
1606
1607 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1608 the compiler.
1609
1610 Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1611 options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1612 executables containing debugging information.
1613
1614 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1615 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1616 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1617 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1618 in pushing your luck.
1619
1620 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1621 @cindex debugging optimized code
1622 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1623 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1624 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1625 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1626 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1627 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1628
1629 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1630 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1631 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1632 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1633
1634 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1635 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1636 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1637
1638 @need 2000
1639 @node Starting
1640 @section Starting your program
1641 @cindex starting
1642 @cindex running
1643
1644 @table @code
1645 @kindex run
1646 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1647 @item run
1648 @itemx r
1649 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1650 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1651 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1652 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1653 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1654
1655 @end table
1656
1657 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1658 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1659 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1660 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1661
1662 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1663 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1664 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1665 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1666 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1667 divided into four categories:
1668
1669 @table @asis
1670 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1671 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1672 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1673 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1674 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1675 the arguments.
1676 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1677 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1678 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1679
1680 @item The @emph{environment.}
1681 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1682 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1683 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1684 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1685
1686 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1687 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1688 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1689 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1690
1691 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1692 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1693 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1694 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1695 set a different device for your program.
1696 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1697
1698 @cindex pipes
1699 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1700 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1701 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1702 wrong program.
1703 @end table
1704
1705 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1706 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1707 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1708 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1709 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1710
1711 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1712 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1713 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1714 your current breakpoints.
1715
1716 @node Arguments
1717 @section Your program's arguments
1718
1719 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1720 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1721 @code{run} command.
1722 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1723 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1724 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1725 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1726 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1727
1728 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1729 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1730 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1731 the program, not by the shell.
1732
1733 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1734 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1735
1736 @table @code
1737 @kindex set args
1738 @item set args
1739 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1740 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1741 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1742 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1743 it again without arguments.
1744
1745 @kindex show args
1746 @item show args
1747 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1748 @end table
1749
1750 @node Environment
1751 @section Your program's environment
1752
1753 @cindex environment (of your program)
1754 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1755 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1756 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1757 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1758 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1759 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1760 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1761
1762 @table @code
1763 @kindex path
1764 @item path @var{directory}
1765 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1766 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1767 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1768 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1769 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1770 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1771 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1772
1773 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1774 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1775 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1776 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1777 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1778 @var{directory} to the search path.
1779 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1780 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1781
1782 @kindex show paths
1783 @item show paths
1784 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1785 environment variable).
1786
1787 @kindex show environment
1788 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1789 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1790 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1791 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1792 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1793
1794 @kindex set environment
1795 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1796 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1797 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1798 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1799 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1800 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1801 null value.
1802 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1803 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1804
1805 For example, this command:
1806
1807 @example
1808 set env USER = foo
1809 @end example
1810
1811 @noindent
1812 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
1813 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1814 are not actually required.)
1815
1816 @kindex unset environment
1817 @item unset environment @var{varname}
1818 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1819 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1820 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1821 rather than assigning it an empty value.
1822 @end table
1823
1824 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1825 the shell indicated
1826 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1827 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1828 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1829 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1830 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1831 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1832 @file{.profile}.
1833
1834 @node Working Directory
1835 @section Your program's working directory
1836
1837 @cindex working directory (of your program)
1838 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1839 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1840 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1841 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1842 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1843
1844 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1845 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1846 specify files}.
1847
1848 @table @code
1849 @kindex cd
1850 @item cd @var{directory}
1851 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1852
1853 @kindex pwd
1854 @item pwd
1855 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1856 @end table
1857
1858 @node Input/Output
1859 @section Your program's input and output
1860
1861 @cindex redirection
1862 @cindex i/o
1863 @cindex terminal
1864 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1865 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1866 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1867 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1868 running your program.
1869
1870 @table @code
1871 @kindex info terminal
1872 @item info terminal
1873 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1874 program is using.
1875 @end table
1876
1877 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1878 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1879
1880 @example
1881 run > outfile
1882 @end example
1883
1884 @noindent
1885 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1886
1887 @kindex tty
1888 @cindex controlling terminal
1889 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1890 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1891 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1892 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1893 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1894
1895 @example
1896 tty /dev/ttyb
1897 @end example
1898
1899 @noindent
1900 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1901 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1902 that as their controlling terminal.
1903
1904 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1905 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1906 terminal.
1907
1908 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1909 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1910 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1911
1912 @node Attach
1913 @section Debugging an already-running process
1914 @kindex attach
1915 @cindex attach
1916
1917 @table @code
1918 @item attach @var{process-id}
1919 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1920 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1921 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1922 find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1923 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1924
1925 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1926 executing the command.
1927 @end table
1928
1929 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1930 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1931 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1932 also have permission to send the process a signal.
1933
1934 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1935 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1936 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1937 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1938 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1939 Specify Files}.
1940
1941 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1942 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
1943 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1944 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1945 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1946 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
1947 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1948
1949 @table @code
1950 @kindex detach
1951 @item detach
1952 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1953 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1954 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1955 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1956 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1957 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1958 executing the command.
1959 @end table
1960
1961 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1962 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1963 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1964 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1965 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1966 messages}).
1967
1968 @node Kill Process
1969 @section Killing the child process
1970
1971 @table @code
1972 @kindex kill
1973 @item kill
1974 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1975 @end table
1976
1977 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1978 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1979 is running.
1980
1981 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1982 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1983 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1984 outside the debugger.
1985
1986 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1987 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1988 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1989 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1990 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1991 breakpoint settings).
1992
1993 @node Threads
1994 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
1995
1996 @cindex threads of execution
1997 @cindex multiple threads
1998 @cindex switching threads
1999 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2000 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2001 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2002 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2003 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2004 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2005 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2006
2007 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2008 programs:
2009
2010 @itemize @bullet
2011 @item automatic notification of new threads
2012 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2013 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2014 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2015 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2016 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2017 @end itemize
2018
2019 @quotation
2020 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2021 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2022 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2023 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2024 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2025 like this:
2026
2027 @smallexample
2028 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2029 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2030 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2031 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2032 @end smallexample
2033 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2034 @c doesn't support threads"?
2035 @end quotation
2036
2037 @cindex focus of debugging
2038 @cindex current thread
2039 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2040 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2041 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2042 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2043 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2044
2045 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2046 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2047 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2048 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2049 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2050 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2051 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2052 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2053 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2054 LynxOS, you might see
2055
2056 @example
2057 [New process 35 thread 27]
2058 @end example
2059
2060 @noindent
2061 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2062 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2063 further qualifier.
2064
2065 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2066 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2067 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2068 @c program?
2069 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2070 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2071 @c threads ab initio?
2072
2073 @cindex thread number
2074 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2075 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2076 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2077
2078 @table @code
2079 @kindex info threads
2080 @item info threads
2081 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2082 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2083
2084 @enumerate
2085 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2086
2087 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2088
2089 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2090 @end enumerate
2091
2092 @noindent
2093 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2094 indicates the current thread.
2095
2096 For example,
2097 @end table
2098 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2099
2100 @smallexample
2101 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2102 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2103 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2104 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2105 at threadtest.c:68
2106 @end smallexample
2107
2108 On HP-UX systems:
2109
2110 @cindex thread number
2111 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2112 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2113 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2114 thread in your program.
2115
2116 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2117 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2118 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2119 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2120 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2121 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2122 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2123 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2124 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2125 HP-UX, you see
2126
2127 @example
2128 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2129 @end example
2130
2131 @noindent
2132 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2133
2134 @table @code
2135 @kindex info threads
2136 @item info threads
2137 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2138 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2139
2140 @enumerate
2141 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2142
2143 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2144
2145 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2146 @end enumerate
2147
2148 @noindent
2149 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2150 indicates the current thread.
2151
2152 For example,
2153 @end table
2154 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2155
2156 @example
2157 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2158 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2159 at quicksort.c:137
2160 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2161 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2162 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2163 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2164 @end example
2165
2166 @table @code
2167 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2168 @item thread @var{threadno}
2169 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2170 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2171 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2172 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2173 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2174
2175 @smallexample
2176 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2177 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2178 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2179 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2180 @end smallexample
2181
2182 @noindent
2183 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2184 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2185 threads.
2186
2187 @kindex thread apply
2188 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2189 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2190 more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2191 with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2192 @value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2193 threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2194 @code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2195 @end table
2196
2197 @cindex automatic thread selection
2198 @cindex switching threads automatically
2199 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2200 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2201 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2202 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2203 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2204 thread.
2205
2206 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2207 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2208 programs with multiple threads.
2209
2210 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2211 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2212
2213 @node Processes
2214 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2215
2216 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2217 @cindex multiple processes
2218 @cindex processes, multiple
2219 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2220 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2221 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2222 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2223 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2224 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2225 will cause it to terminate.
2226
2227 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2228 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2229 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2230 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2231 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2232 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2233 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2234 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2235 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2236 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2237
2238 On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2239 debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2240 @code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
2241
2242 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2243 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2244
2245 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2246 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2247
2248 @table @code
2249 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2250 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2251 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2252 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2253 process. The @var{mode} can be:
2254
2255 @table @code
2256 @item parent
2257 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2258 unimpeded. This is the default.
2259
2260 @item child
2261 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2262 unimpeded.
2263
2264 @item ask
2265 The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2266 @end table
2267
2268 @item show follow-fork-mode
2269 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2270 @end table
2271
2272 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2273 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2274 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2275 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2276 the child process's @code{main}.
2277
2278 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2279 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2280
2281 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2282 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2283 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2284 argument.
2285
2286 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2287 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2288 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2289
2290 @node Stopping
2291 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2292
2293 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2294 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2295 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2296
2297 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2298 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2299 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2300 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2301 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2302 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2303 explicitly request this information at any time.
2304
2305 @table @code
2306 @kindex info program
2307 @item info program
2308 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2309 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2310 @end table
2311
2312 @menu
2313 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2314 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2315 * Signals:: Signals
2316 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2317 @end menu
2318
2319 @node Breakpoints
2320 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2321
2322 @cindex breakpoints
2323 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2324 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2325 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2326 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2327 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2328 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2329 program.
2330
2331 In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2332 breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2333 a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2334 is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2335 not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2336 arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2337
2338 @cindex watchpoints
2339 @cindex memory tracing
2340 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2341 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2342 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2343 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2344 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2345 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2346 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2347 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2348
2349 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2350 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2351 Automatic display}.
2352
2353 @cindex catchpoints
2354 @cindex breakpoint on events
2355 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2356 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2357 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2358 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2359 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2360 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2361 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2362
2363 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2364 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2365 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2366 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2367 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2368 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2369 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2370 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2371 enable it again.
2372
2373 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2374 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2375 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2376 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2377 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2378 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2379 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2380
2381 @menu
2382 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2383 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2384 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2385 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2386 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2387 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2388 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2389 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2390 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2391 @end menu
2392
2393 @node Set Breaks
2394 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2395
2396 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2397 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2398 @c
2399 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2400
2401 @kindex break
2402 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2403 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2404 @cindex latest breakpoint
2405 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2406 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2407 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2408 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2409 convenience variables.
2410
2411 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2412
2413 @table @code
2414 @item break @var{function}
2415 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2416 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2417 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2418 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2419
2420 @item break +@var{offset}
2421 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2422 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2423 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2424 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2425
2426 @item break @var{linenum}
2427 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2428 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2429 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2430 code on that line.
2431
2432 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2433 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2434
2435 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2436 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2437 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2438 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2439 functions.
2440
2441 @item break *@var{address}
2442 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2443 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2444 information or source files.
2445
2446 @item break
2447 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2448 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2449 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2450 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2451 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2452 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2453 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2454 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2455 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2456 inside loops.
2457
2458 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2459 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2460 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2461 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2462 existed when your program stopped.
2463
2464 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2465 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2466 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2467 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2468 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2469 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2470 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2471
2472 @kindex tbreak
2473 @item tbreak @var{args}
2474 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2475 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2476 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2477 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2478
2479 @kindex hbreak
2480 @item hbreak @var{args}
2481 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2482 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2483 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2484 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2485 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2486 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2487 provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2488 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2489 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2490 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2491 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2492 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2493 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2494 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2495
2496 @kindex thbreak
2497 @item thbreak @var{args}
2498 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2499 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2500 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2501 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2502 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2503 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2504 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2505 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2506
2507 @kindex rbreak
2508 @cindex regular expression
2509 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2510 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2511 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2512 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2513 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2514 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2515 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2516
2517 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2518 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2519 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2520 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2521 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2522 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2523
2524 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2525 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2526 classes.
2527
2528 @kindex info breakpoints
2529 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2530 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2531 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2532 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2533 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2534 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2535
2536 @table @emph
2537 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2538 @item Type
2539 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2540 @item Disposition
2541 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2542 @item Enabled or Disabled
2543 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2544 that are not enabled.
2545 @item Address
2546 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
2547 @item What
2548 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2549 line number.
2550 @end table
2551
2552 @noindent
2553 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2554 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2555 are listed after that.
2556
2557 @noindent
2558 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
2559 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2560 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2561 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2562 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2563
2564 @noindent
2565 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2566 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2567 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2568 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2569 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2570 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2571 @end table
2572
2573 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2574 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2575 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2576 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2577
2578 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2579 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2580 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2581 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2582 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2583 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2584 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2585 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
2586
2587
2588 @node Set Watchpoints
2589 @subsection Setting watchpoints
2590
2591 @cindex setting watchpoints
2592 @cindex software watchpoints
2593 @cindex hardware watchpoints
2594 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2595 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2596 this may happen.
2597
2598 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2599 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2600 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2601 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2602 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2603 culprit.)
2604
2605 On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2606 @value{GDBN} includes support for
2607 hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2608 program.
2609
2610 @table @code
2611 @kindex watch
2612 @item watch @var{expr}
2613 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2614 is written into by the program and its value changes.
2615
2616 @kindex rwatch
2617 @item rwatch @var{expr}
2618 Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
2619
2620 @kindex awatch
2621 @item awatch @var{expr}
2622 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
2623 by the program.
2624
2625 @kindex info watchpoints
2626 @item info watchpoints
2627 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2628 it is the same as @code{info break}.
2629 @end table
2630
2631 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2632 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2633 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2634 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2635 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2636 statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2637
2638 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2639
2640 @example
2641 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2642 @end example
2643
2644 @noindent
2645 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2646
2647 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2648 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2649 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2650 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2651 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2652 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2653 will print a message like this:
2654
2655 @smallexample
2656 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2657 @end smallexample
2658
2659 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2660 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2661 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2662 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2663 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2664 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2665 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2666 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2667
2668 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2669 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2670 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2671 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2672 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2673 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2674
2675 @smallexample
2676 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2677 @end smallexample
2678
2679 @noindent
2680 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2681
2682 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2683 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2684 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2685 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2686 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2687 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2688 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2689 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
2690 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2691 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2692
2693 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2694 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
2695 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2696
2697 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2698 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2699 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2700 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2701 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2702 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2703 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2704 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2705 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2706
2707 @quotation
2708 @cindex watchpoints and threads
2709 @cindex threads and watchpoints
2710 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2711 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2712 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2713 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2714 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2715 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2716 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2717 the expression.
2718
2719 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
2720 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2721 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2722 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2723 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2724 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2725 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2726 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2727 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2728 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
2729 @end quotation
2730
2731 @node Set Catchpoints
2732 @subsection Setting catchpoints
2733 @cindex catchpoints, setting
2734 @cindex exception handlers
2735 @cindex event handling
2736
2737 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2738 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
2739 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2740
2741 @table @code
2742 @kindex catch
2743 @item catch @var{event}
2744 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2745 @table @code
2746 @item throw
2747 @kindex catch throw
2748 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
2749
2750 @item catch
2751 @kindex catch catch
2752 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
2753
2754 @item exec
2755 @kindex catch exec
2756 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2757
2758 @item fork
2759 @kindex catch fork
2760 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2761
2762 @item vfork
2763 @kindex catch vfork
2764 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2765
2766 @item load
2767 @itemx load @var{libname}
2768 @kindex catch load
2769 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2770 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2771
2772 @item unload
2773 @itemx unload @var{libname}
2774 @kindex catch unload
2775 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2776 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2777 @end table
2778
2779 @item tcatch @var{event}
2780 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2781 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2782
2783 @end table
2784
2785 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2786
2787 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
2788 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2789
2790 @itemize @bullet
2791 @item
2792 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2793 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2794 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2795 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2796 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2797 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2798 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2799 disabled within interactive calls.
2800
2801 @item
2802 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2803
2804 @item
2805 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2806 @end itemize
2807
2808 @cindex raise exceptions
2809 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2810 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2811 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2812 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2813 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2814 out where the exception was raised.
2815
2816 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2817 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
2818 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2819 which has the following ANSI C interface:
2820
2821 @example
2822 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
2823 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2824 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
2825 @end example
2826
2827 @noindent
2828 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2829 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2830 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2831
2832 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2833 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2834 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2835 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2836 raised.
2837
2838
2839 @node Delete Breaks
2840 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
2841
2842 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2843 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2844 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2845 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2846 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2847 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2848
2849 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2850 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2851 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2852 their breakpoint numbers.
2853
2854 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2855 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2856 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2857
2858 @table @code
2859 @kindex clear
2860 @item clear
2861 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2862 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2863 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2864 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2865
2866 @item clear @var{function}
2867 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2868 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2869
2870 @item clear @var{linenum}
2871 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2872 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2873
2874 @cindex delete breakpoints
2875 @kindex delete
2876 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
2877 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2878 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2879 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
2880 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2881 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2882 @end table
2883
2884 @node Disabling
2885 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
2886
2887 @kindex disable breakpoints
2888 @kindex enable breakpoints
2889 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2890 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2891 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2892 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2893
2894 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2895 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2896 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2897 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2898 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2899
2900 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2901 states of enablement:
2902
2903 @itemize @bullet
2904 @item
2905 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2906 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2907 @item
2908 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2909 @item
2910 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
2911 disabled.
2912 @item
2913 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
2914 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2915 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
2916 @end itemize
2917
2918 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2919 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2920
2921 @table @code
2922 @kindex disable breakpoints
2923 @kindex disable
2924 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
2925 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2926 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2927 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2928 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2929 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2930 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2931
2932 @kindex enable breakpoints
2933 @kindex enable
2934 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2935 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2936 become effective once again in stopping your program.
2937
2938 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
2939 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2940 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2941
2942 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
2943 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2944 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2945 @end table
2946
2947 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2948 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
2949 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2950 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2951 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2952 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2953 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2954 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2955 stepping}.)
2956
2957 @node Conditions
2958 @subsection Break conditions
2959 @cindex conditional breakpoints
2960 @cindex breakpoint conditions
2961
2962 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
2963 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
2964 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2965 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2966 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2967 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2968 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2969 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2970
2971 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2972 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2973 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2974 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2975 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2976
2977 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2978 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2979 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2980 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2981 one.
2982
2983 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2984 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2985 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2986 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2987 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2988 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2989 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
2990 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2991 conditions for the
2992 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2993 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2994
2995 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2996 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2997 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2998 with the @code{condition} command.
2999
3000 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3001 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3002 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3003 catchpoint.
3004
3005 @table @code
3006 @kindex condition
3007 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3008 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3009 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3010 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3011 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3012 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3013 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3014 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3015 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3016 prints an error message:
3017
3018 @example
3019 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3020 @end example
3021
3022 @noindent
3023 @value{GDBN} does
3024 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3025 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3026 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3027
3028 @item condition @var{bnum}
3029 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3030 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3031 @end table
3032
3033 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3034 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3035 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3036 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3037 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3038 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3039 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3040 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3041 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3042 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3043 your program reaches it.
3044
3045 @table @code
3046 @kindex ignore
3047 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3048 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3049 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3050 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3051 takes no action.
3052
3053 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3054 a count of zero.
3055
3056 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3057 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3058 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3059 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3060
3061 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3062 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3063 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3064
3065 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3066 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3067 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3068 variables}.
3069 @end table
3070
3071 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3072
3073
3074 @node Break Commands
3075 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3076
3077 @cindex breakpoint commands
3078 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3079 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3080 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3081 enable other breakpoints.
3082
3083 @table @code
3084 @kindex commands
3085 @kindex end
3086 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3087 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3088 @itemx end
3089 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3090 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3091 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3092
3093 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3094 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3095
3096 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3097 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3098 recently encountered).
3099 @end table
3100
3101 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3102 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3103
3104 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3105 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3106 that resumes execution.
3107
3108 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3109 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3110 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3111 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3112 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3113
3114 @kindex silent
3115 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3116 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3117 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3118 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3119 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3120 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3121
3122 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3123 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3124 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3125
3126 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3127 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3128
3129 @example
3130 break foo if x>0
3131 commands
3132 silent
3133 printf "x is %d\n",x
3134 cont
3135 end
3136 @end example
3137
3138 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3139 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3140 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3141 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3142 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3143 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3144 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3145
3146 @example
3147 break 403
3148 commands
3149 silent
3150 set x = y + 4
3151 cont
3152 end
3153 @end example
3154
3155 @node Breakpoint Menus
3156 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3157 @cindex overloading
3158 @cindex symbol overloading
3159
3160 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
3161 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3162 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3163 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3164 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3165 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3166 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3167 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3168 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3169 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3170 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3171 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3172 breakpoints.
3173
3174 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3175 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3176 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3177
3178 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3179 @smallexample
3180 @group
3181 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3182 [0] cancel
3183 [1] all
3184 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3185 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3186 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3187 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3188 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3189 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3190 > 2 4 6
3191 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3192 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3193 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3194 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3195 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3196 breakpoints.
3197 (@value{GDBP})
3198 @end group
3199 @end smallexample
3200
3201 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3202 @node Error in Breakpoints
3203 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3204 @c
3205 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3206 @c
3207 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3208 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3209 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3210 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3211
3212 @example
3213 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3214 The same program may be running in another process.
3215 @end example
3216
3217 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3218
3219 @enumerate
3220 @item
3221 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3222
3223 @item
3224 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3225 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3226 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3227 Then start your program again.
3228
3229 @item
3230 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3231 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3232 to nonsharable executables.
3233 @end enumerate
3234 @c @end ifclear
3235
3236 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3237 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3238
3239 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3240 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3241 @smallexample
3242 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3243 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3244 @end smallexample
3245
3246 @noindent
3247 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3248 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3249 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3250
3251 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3252 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3253
3254
3255 @node Continuing and Stepping
3256 @section Continuing and stepping
3257
3258 @cindex stepping
3259 @cindex continuing
3260 @cindex resuming execution
3261 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3262 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3263 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3264 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3265 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3266 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3267 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3268 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3269
3270 @table @code
3271 @kindex continue
3272 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3273 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3274 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3275 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3276 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3277 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3278 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3279 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3280 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3281 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3282
3283 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3284 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3285 @code{continue} is ignored.
3286
3287 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3288 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3289 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3290 @code{continue}.
3291 @end table
3292
3293 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3294 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3295 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3296 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3297
3298 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3299 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3300 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3301 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3302 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3303 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3304
3305 @table @code
3306 @kindex step
3307 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3308 @item step
3309 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3310 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3311 abbreviated @code{s}.
3312
3313 @quotation
3314 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3315 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3316 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3317 @c distinction here.
3318 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3319 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3320 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3321 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3322 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3323 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3324 below.
3325 @end quotation
3326
3327 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3328 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3329 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3330 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3331 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3332 called within the line.
3333
3334 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3335 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3336 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3337 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3338 was any debugging information about the routine.
3339
3340 @item step @var{count}
3341 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3342 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3343 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3344
3345 @kindex next
3346 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3347 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3348 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3349 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3350 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3351 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3352 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3353 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3354
3355 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3356
3357
3358 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3359 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3360 @c
3361 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3362 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3363 @c function are executed without stopping.
3364
3365 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3366 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3367 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3368
3369 @kindex set step-mode
3370 @item set step-mode
3371 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3372 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3373 @itemx set step-mode on
3374 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3375 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3376 information rather than stepping over it.
3377
3378 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3379 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3380 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3381
3382 @item set step-mode off
3383 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3384 debug information. This is the default.
3385
3386 @kindex finish
3387 @item finish
3388 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3389 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3390
3391 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3392 ,Returning from a function}).
3393
3394 @kindex until
3395 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3396 @item until
3397 @itemx u
3398 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3399 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3400 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3401 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3402 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3403 than the address of the jump.
3404
3405 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3406 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3407 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3408 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3409 through the next iteration.
3410
3411 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3412 stack frame.
3413
3414 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3415 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3416 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3417 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3418 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3419
3420 @example
3421 (@value{GDBP}) f
3422 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3423 206 expand_input();
3424 (@value{GDBP}) until
3425 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3426 @end example
3427
3428 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3429 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3430 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3431 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3432 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3433 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3434 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3435
3436 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3437 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3438 argument.
3439
3440 @item until @var{location}
3441 @itemx u @var{location}
3442 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3443 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3444 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3445 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3446 and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3447
3448 @kindex stepi
3449 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
3450 @item stepi
3451 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
3452 @itemx si
3453 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3454
3455 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3456 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3457 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3458 Display,, Automatic display}.
3459
3460 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3461
3462 @need 750
3463 @kindex nexti
3464 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
3465 @item nexti
3466 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
3467 @itemx ni
3468 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3469 proceed until the function returns.
3470
3471 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3472 @end table
3473
3474 @node Signals
3475 @section Signals
3476 @cindex signals
3477
3478 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3479 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3480 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3481 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3482 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3483 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3484 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3485 requested an alarm).
3486
3487 @cindex fatal signals
3488 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3489 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3490 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3491 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3492 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3493 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3494
3495 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3496 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3497 signal.
3498
3499 @cindex handling signals
3500 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3501 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3502 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
3503 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3504 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3505
3506 @table @code
3507 @kindex info signals
3508 @item info signals
3509 @itemx info handle
3510 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3511 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3512 the defined types of signals.
3513
3514 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3515
3516 @kindex handle
3517 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3518 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3519 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
3520 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
3521 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3522 known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3523 @end table
3524
3525 @c @group
3526 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3527 Their full names are:
3528
3529 @table @code
3530 @item nostop
3531 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3532 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3533
3534 @item stop
3535 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3536 the @code{print} keyword as well.
3537
3538 @item print
3539 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3540
3541 @item noprint
3542 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3543 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3544
3545 @item pass
3546 @itemx noignore
3547 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3548 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3549 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
3550
3551 @item nopass
3552 @itemx ignore
3553 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3554 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
3555 @end table
3556 @c @end group
3557
3558 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3559 program until you
3560 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3561 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3562 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3563 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3564 program sees that signal when you continue.
3565
3566 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3567 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3568 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3569 erroneous signals.
3570
3571 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3572 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3573 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3574 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3575 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3576 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3577 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3578 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3579 program a signal}.
3580
3581 @node Thread Stops
3582 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3583
3584 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3585 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3586 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3587
3588 @table @code
3589 @cindex breakpoints and threads
3590 @cindex thread breakpoints
3591 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3592 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3593 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3594 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3595 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3596
3597 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3598 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3599 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3600 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3601 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3602
3603 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3604 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3605 program.
3606
3607 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3608 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3609 breakpoint condition, like this:
3610
3611 @smallexample
3612 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3613 @end smallexample
3614
3615 @end table
3616
3617 @cindex stopped threads
3618 @cindex threads, stopped
3619 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3620 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3621 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3622 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3623 underfoot.
3624
3625 @cindex continuing threads
3626 @cindex threads, continuing
3627 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3628 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3629 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3630
3631 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3632 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3633 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3634 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3635 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3636 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3637 stops.
3638
3639 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3640 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3641 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3642 first thread completes whatever you requested.
3643
3644 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3645 thread to run.
3646
3647 @table @code
3648 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3649 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3650 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3651 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3652 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3653 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3654 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
3655 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
3656 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
3657 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
3658 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3659 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3660
3661 @item show scheduler-locking
3662 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3663 @end table
3664
3665
3666 @node Stack
3667 @chapter Examining the Stack
3668
3669 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3670 stopped and how it got there.
3671
3672 @cindex call stack
3673 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3674 is generated.
3675 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3676 the arguments of the call,
3677 and the local variables of the function being called.
3678 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3679 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3680 stack}.
3681
3682 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3683 stack allow you to see all of this information.
3684
3685 @cindex selected frame
3686 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3687 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3688 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3689 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3690 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3691 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3692
3693 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3694 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3695 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3696
3697 @menu
3698 * Frames:: Stack frames
3699 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
3700 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
3701 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
3702
3703 @end menu
3704
3705 @node Frames
3706 @section Stack frames
3707
3708 @cindex frame, definition
3709 @cindex stack frame
3710 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3711 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3712 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3713 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3714 which the function is executing.
3715
3716 @cindex initial frame
3717 @cindex outermost frame
3718 @cindex innermost frame
3719 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3720 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3721 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3722 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3723 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3724 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3725 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3726 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3727
3728 @cindex frame pointer
3729 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3730 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3731 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3732 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3733 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3734 going on in that frame.
3735
3736 @cindex frame number
3737 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3738 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3739 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3740 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3741 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3742
3743 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3744 @c underflow problems.
3745 @cindex frameless execution
3746 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3747 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3748 @example
3749 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3750 @end example
3751 generates functions without a frame.)
3752 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3753 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3754 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3755 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3756 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3757 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3758 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3759
3760 @table @code
3761 @kindex frame@r{, command}
3762 @cindex current stack frame
3763 @item frame @var{args}
3764 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3765 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3766 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3767 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3768
3769 @kindex select-frame
3770 @cindex selecting frame silently
3771 @item select-frame
3772 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3773 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3774 @code{frame}.
3775 @end table
3776
3777 @node Backtrace
3778 @section Backtraces
3779
3780 @cindex backtraces
3781 @cindex tracebacks
3782 @cindex stack traces
3783 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3784 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3785 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3786 stack.
3787
3788 @table @code
3789 @kindex backtrace
3790 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
3791 @item backtrace
3792 @itemx bt
3793 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3794 frames in the stack.
3795
3796 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3797 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3798
3799 @item backtrace @var{n}
3800 @itemx bt @var{n}
3801 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3802
3803 @item backtrace -@var{n}
3804 @itemx bt -@var{n}
3805 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3806 @end table
3807
3808 @kindex where
3809 @kindex info stack
3810 @kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
3811 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3812 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3813
3814 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3815 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3816 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3817 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3818 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3819 line number.
3820
3821 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3822 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3823
3824 @smallexample
3825 @group
3826 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3827 at builtin.c:993
3828 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3829 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3830 at macro.c:71
3831 (More stack frames follow...)
3832 @end group
3833 @end smallexample
3834
3835 @noindent
3836 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3837 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3838 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3839
3840 @node Selection
3841 @section Selecting a frame
3842
3843 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3844 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3845 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3846 of the stack frame just selected.
3847
3848 @table @code
3849 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
3850 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
3851 @item frame @var{n}
3852 @itemx f @var{n}
3853 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3854 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3855 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3856 @code{main}.
3857
3858 @item frame @var{addr}
3859 @itemx f @var{addr}
3860 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3861 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3862 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3863 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3864 switches between them.
3865
3866 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3867 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3868
3869 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3870 pointer and a program counter.
3871
3872 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3873 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3874 @c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3875 @c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3876 @c as of 27 Jan 1994.
3877
3878 @kindex up
3879 @item up @var{n}
3880 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3881 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3882 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3883
3884 @kindex down
3885 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
3886 @item down @var{n}
3887 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3888 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3889 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3890 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3891 @end table
3892
3893 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3894 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3895 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3896 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
3897
3898 @need 1000
3899 For example:
3900
3901 @smallexample
3902 @group
3903 (@value{GDBP}) up
3904 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3905 at env.c:10
3906 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3907 @end group
3908 @end smallexample
3909
3910 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3911 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3912 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3913
3914 @table @code
3915 @kindex down-silently
3916 @kindex up-silently
3917 @item up-silently @var{n}
3918 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
3919 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3920 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3921 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3922 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3923 distracting.
3924 @end table
3925
3926 @node Frame Info
3927 @section Information about a frame
3928
3929 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3930 stack frame.
3931
3932 @table @code
3933 @item frame
3934 @itemx f
3935 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3936 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3937 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3938 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3939 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3940
3941 @kindex info frame
3942 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
3943 @item info frame
3944 @itemx info f
3945 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3946 including:
3947
3948 @itemize @bullet
3949 @item
3950 the address of the frame
3951 @item
3952 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3953 @item
3954 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3955 @item
3956 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3957 @item
3958 the address of the frame's arguments
3959 @item
3960 the address of the frame's local variables
3961 @item
3962 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3963 @item
3964 which registers were saved in the frame
3965 @end itemize
3966
3967 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
3968 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3969 the usual conventions.
3970
3971 @item info frame @var{addr}
3972 @itemx info f @var{addr}
3973 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3974 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3975 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3976 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3977 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3978
3979 @kindex info args
3980 @item info args
3981 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3982
3983 @item info locals
3984 @kindex info locals
3985 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3986 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3987 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3988
3989 @kindex info catch
3990 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3991 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
3992 @item info catch
3993 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3994 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3995 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3996 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3997 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
3998
3999 @end table
4000
4001
4002 @node Source
4003 @chapter Examining Source Files
4004
4005 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4006 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4007 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4008 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4009 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4010 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4011 source files by explicit command.
4012
4013 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4014 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4015 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4016
4017 @menu
4018 * List:: Printing source lines
4019 * Search:: Searching source files
4020 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4021 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4022 @end menu
4023
4024 @node List
4025 @section Printing source lines
4026
4027 @kindex list
4028 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4029 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4030 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4031 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4032
4033 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4034
4035 @table @code
4036 @item list @var{linenum}
4037 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4038 current source file.
4039
4040 @item list @var{function}
4041 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4042 @var{function}.
4043
4044 @item list
4045 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4046 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4047 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4048 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4049 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4050
4051 @item list -
4052 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4053 @end table
4054
4055 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4056 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4057
4058 @table @code
4059 @kindex set listsize
4060 @item set listsize @var{count}
4061 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4062 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4063
4064 @kindex show listsize
4065 @item show listsize
4066 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4067 @end table
4068
4069 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4070 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4071 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4072 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4073 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4074
4075 @cindex linespec
4076 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4077 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4078 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4079 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4080
4081 @table @code
4082 @item list @var{linespec}
4083 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4084
4085 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4086 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4087 linespecs.
4088
4089 @item list ,@var{last}
4090 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4091
4092 @item list @var{first},
4093 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4094
4095 @item list +
4096 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4097
4098 @item list -
4099 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4100
4101 @item list
4102 As described in the preceding table.
4103 @end table
4104
4105 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4106 kinds of linespec.
4107
4108 @table @code
4109 @item @var{number}
4110 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4111 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4112 the same source file as the first linespec.
4113
4114 @item +@var{offset}
4115 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4116 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4117 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4118 first linespec.
4119
4120 @item -@var{offset}
4121 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4122
4123 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4124 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4125
4126 @item @var{function}
4127 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4128 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4129
4130 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4131 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4132 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4133 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4134 identically named functions in different source files.
4135
4136 @item *@var{address}
4137 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4138 @var{address} may be any expression.
4139 @end table
4140
4141 @node Search
4142 @section Searching source files
4143 @cindex searching
4144 @kindex reverse-search
4145
4146 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4147 regular expression.
4148
4149 @table @code
4150 @kindex search
4151 @kindex forward-search
4152 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4153 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4154 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4155 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4156 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4157 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4158 @code{fo}.
4159
4160 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4161 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4162 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4163 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4164 this command as @code{rev}.
4165 @end table
4166
4167 @node Source Path
4168 @section Specifying source directories
4169
4170 @cindex source path
4171 @cindex directories for source files
4172 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4173 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4174 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4175 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4176 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4177 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4178 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4179 the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4180 the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4181 path.
4182
4183 If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4184 object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4185 too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4186 compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4187 last resort.
4188
4189 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4190 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4191 each line is in the file.
4192
4193 @kindex directory
4194 @kindex dir
4195 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4196 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
4197 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4198
4199 @table @code
4200 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4201 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4202 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
4203 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4204 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4205 part of absolute file names) or
4206 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4207 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4208
4209 @kindex cdir
4210 @kindex cwd
4211 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4212 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
4213 @cindex compilation directory
4214 @cindex current directory
4215 @cindex working directory
4216 @cindex directory, current
4217 @cindex directory, compilation
4218 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4219 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4220 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4221 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4222 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4223 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4224
4225 @item directory
4226 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4227
4228 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4229 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4230
4231 @item show directories
4232 @kindex show directories
4233 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4234 @end table
4235
4236 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4237 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4238 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4239
4240 @enumerate
4241 @item
4242 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4243
4244 @item
4245 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4246 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4247 directories in one command.
4248 @end enumerate
4249
4250 @node Machine Code
4251 @section Source and machine code
4252
4253 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4254 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4255 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
4256 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
4257 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4258 well as hex.
4259
4260 @table @code
4261 @kindex info line
4262 @item info line @var{linespec}
4263 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4264 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4265 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4266 source lines}).
4267 @end table
4268
4269 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4270 the object code for the first line of function
4271 @code{m4_changequote}:
4272
4273 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4274 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
4275 @smallexample
4276 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
4277 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4278 @end smallexample
4279
4280 @noindent
4281 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4282 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4283 @smallexample
4284 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4285 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4286 @end smallexample
4287
4288 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4289 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
4290 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4291 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4292 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4293 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4294 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4295 variables}).
4296
4297 @table @code
4298 @kindex disassemble
4299 @cindex assembly instructions
4300 @cindex instructions, assembly
4301 @cindex machine instructions
4302 @cindex listing machine instructions
4303 @item disassemble
4304 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4305 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4306 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4307 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4308 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4309 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4310 @end table
4311
4312 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4313 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4314
4315 @smallexample
4316 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4317 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4318 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
4319 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4320 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4321 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4322 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
4323 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
4324 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4325 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4326 End of assembler dump.
4327 @end smallexample
4328
4329 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4330 mnemonics or other syntax.
4331
4332 @table @code
4333 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
4334 @cindex assembly instructions
4335 @cindex instructions, assembly
4336 @cindex machine instructions
4337 @cindex listing machine instructions
4338 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4339 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4340 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4341 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4342 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4343
4344 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
4345 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4346 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4347 assemblers for x86-based targets.
4348 @end table
4349
4350
4351 @node Data
4352 @chapter Examining Data
4353
4354 @cindex printing data
4355 @cindex examining data
4356 @kindex print
4357 @kindex inspect
4358 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4359 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4360 @c different window or something like that.
4361 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4362 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4363 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4364 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4365 Different Languages}).
4366
4367 @table @code
4368 @item print @var{expr}
4369 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4370 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4371 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
4372 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
4373 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
4374 formats}.
4375
4376 @item print
4377 @itemx print /@var{f}
4378 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
4379 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4380 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4381 @end table
4382
4383 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4384 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4385 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4386
4387 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
4388 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4389 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
4390 Table}.
4391
4392 @menu
4393 * Expressions:: Expressions
4394 * Variables:: Program variables
4395 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4396 * Output Formats:: Output formats
4397 * Memory:: Examining memory
4398 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
4399 * Print Settings:: Print settings
4400 * Value History:: Value history
4401 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4402 * Registers:: Registers
4403 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
4404 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
4405 @end menu
4406
4407 @node Expressions
4408 @section Expressions
4409
4410 @cindex expressions
4411 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4412 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4413 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4414 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4415 and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4416 by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4417
4418 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4419 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4420 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4421 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
4422
4423 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4424 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4425 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4426 languages.
4427
4428 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4429 expressions regardless of your programming language.
4430
4431 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4432 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4433 at that address in memory.
4434 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
4435
4436 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4437 to programming languages:
4438
4439 @table @code
4440 @item @@
4441 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4442 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4443
4444 @item ::
4445 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4446 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4447
4448 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
4449 @cindex type casting memory
4450 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4451 @cindex casts, to view memory
4452 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4453 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4454 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4455 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4456 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4457 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4458 @end table
4459
4460 @node Variables
4461 @section Program variables
4462
4463 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4464 in your program.
4465
4466 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4467 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4468
4469 @itemize @bullet
4470 @item
4471 global (or file-static)
4472 @end itemize
4473
4474 @noindent or
4475
4476 @itemize @bullet
4477 @item
4478 visible according to the scope rules of the
4479 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4480 @end itemize
4481
4482 @noindent This means that in the function
4483
4484 @example
4485 foo (a)
4486 int a;
4487 @{
4488 bar (a);
4489 @{
4490 int b = test ();
4491 bar (b);
4492 @}
4493 @}
4494 @end example
4495
4496 @noindent
4497 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4498 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4499 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4500 the block where @code{b} is declared.
4501
4502 @cindex variable name conflict
4503 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4504 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4505 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4506 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4507 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4508 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4509 using the colon-colon notation:
4510
4511 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
4512 @iftex
4513 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4514 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
4515 @end iftex
4516 @example
4517 @var{file}::@var{variable}
4518 @var{function}::@var{variable}
4519 @end example
4520
4521 @noindent
4522 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4523 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4524 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4525 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4526
4527 @example
4528 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4529 @end example
4530
4531 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
4532 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4533 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
4534 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4535 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4536 @c conflict?? --mew
4537
4538 @cindex wrong values
4539 @cindex variable values, wrong
4540 @quotation
4541 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4542 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4543 scope, and just before exit.
4544 @end quotation
4545 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4546 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4547 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4548 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4549 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4550 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4551 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4552 variable definitions may be gone.
4553
4554 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4555 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4556 when compiling.
4557
4558 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4559 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4560 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4561 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4562 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4563 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4564 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4565
4566 @example
4567 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4568 @end example
4569
4570 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4571 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4572 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
4573 supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4574 in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
4575 to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
4576 debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4577 Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4578 information.
4579
4580
4581 @node Arrays
4582 @section Artificial arrays
4583
4584 @cindex artificial array
4585 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
4586 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4587 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4588 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4589 program.
4590
4591 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4592 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4593 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4594 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4595 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4596 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4597 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4598 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4599 example. If a program says
4600
4601 @example
4602 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4603 @end example
4604
4605 @noindent
4606 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4607
4608 @example
4609 p *array@@len
4610 @end example
4611
4612 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4613 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4614 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4615 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4616 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4617
4618 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4619 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4620 The value need not be in memory:
4621 @example
4622 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4623 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4624 @end example
4625
4626 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
4627 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
4628 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4629 @example
4630 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4631 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4632 @end example
4633
4634 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4635 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4636 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4637 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4638 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4639 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4640 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4641 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4642 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4643 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4644
4645 @example
4646 set $i = 0
4647 p dtab[$i++]->fv
4648 @key{RET}
4649 @key{RET}
4650 @dots{}
4651 @end example
4652
4653 @node Output Formats
4654 @section Output formats
4655
4656 @cindex formatted output
4657 @cindex output formats
4658 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4659 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4660 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4661 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4662 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4663
4664 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4665 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4666 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4667 letters supported are:
4668
4669 @table @code
4670 @item x
4671 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4672 hexadecimal.
4673
4674 @item d
4675 Print as integer in signed decimal.
4676
4677 @item u
4678 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4679
4680 @item o
4681 Print as integer in octal.
4682
4683 @item t
4684 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4685 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4686 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
4687 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
4688
4689 @item a
4690 @cindex unknown address, locating
4691 @cindex locate address
4692 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4693 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4694 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4695
4696 @example
4697 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4698 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4699 @end example
4700
4701 @noindent
4702 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4703 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4704
4705 @item c
4706 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4707
4708 @item f
4709 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4710 using typical floating point syntax.
4711 @end table
4712
4713 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4714
4715 @example
4716 p/x $pc
4717 @end example
4718
4719 @noindent
4720 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4721 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4722
4723 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4724 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4725 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4726
4727 @node Memory
4728 @section Examining memory
4729
4730 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4731 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4732
4733 @cindex examining memory
4734 @table @code
4735 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
4736 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4737 @itemx x @var{addr}
4738 @itemx x
4739 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4740 @end table
4741
4742 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4743 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4744 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4745 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4746 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4747
4748 @table @r
4749 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
4750 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4751 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4752 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4753 @c 4.1.2.
4754
4755 @item @var{f}, the display format
4756 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4757 @samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4758 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4759 The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4760
4761 @item @var{u}, the unit size
4762 The unit size is any of
4763
4764 @table @code
4765 @item b
4766 Bytes.
4767 @item h
4768 Halfwords (two bytes).
4769 @item w
4770 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4771 @item g
4772 Giant words (eight bytes).
4773 @end table
4774
4775 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4776 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4777 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4778
4779 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
4780 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4781 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4782 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4783 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4784 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4785 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4786 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4787 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4788 a value from memory).
4789 @end table
4790
4791 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4792 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4793 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4794 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
4795 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
4796
4797 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4798 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4799 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4800 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4801 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4802
4803 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4804 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4805 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4806 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
4807 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
4808 Code,,Source and machine code}.
4809
4810 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4811 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4812 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4813 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4814 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4815 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4816 for successive uses of @code{x}.
4817
4818 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4819 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4820 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4821 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4822 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4823 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4824 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4825 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4826 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4827
4828 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4829 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4830 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4831
4832 @node Auto Display
4833 @section Automatic display
4834 @cindex automatic display
4835 @cindex display of expressions
4836
4837 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4838 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4839 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4840 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4841 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4842 The automatic display looks like this:
4843
4844 @example
4845 2: foo = 38
4846 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4847 @end example
4848
4849 @noindent
4850 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4851 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4852 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4853 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4854 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4855 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4856 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4857
4858 @table @code
4859 @kindex display
4860 @item display @var{expr}
4861 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
4862 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4863
4864 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4865
4866 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
4867 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
4868 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
4869 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4870 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4871
4872 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4873 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4874 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4875 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4876 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4877 @end table
4878
4879 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4880 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
4881 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
4882
4883 @table @code
4884 @kindex delete display
4885 @kindex undisplay
4886 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4887 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4888 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4889
4890 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4891 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4892
4893 @kindex disable display
4894 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4895 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4896 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4897 enabled again later.
4898
4899 @kindex enable display
4900 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4901 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4902 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4903
4904 @item display
4905 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4906 done when your program stops.
4907
4908 @kindex info display
4909 @item info display
4910 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4911 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4912 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4913 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4914 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4915 @end table
4916
4917 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4918 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4919 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4920 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4921 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4922 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4923 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4924 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4925 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4926 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4927
4928 @node Print Settings
4929 @section Print settings
4930
4931 @cindex format options
4932 @cindex print settings
4933 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4934 and symbols are printed.
4935
4936 @noindent
4937 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4938
4939 @table @code
4940 @kindex set print address
4941 @item set print address
4942 @itemx set print address on
4943 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4944 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4945 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4946 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4947 @code{set print address on}:
4948
4949 @smallexample
4950 @group
4951 (@value{GDBP}) f
4952 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4953 at input.c:530
4954 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4955 @end group
4956 @end smallexample
4957
4958 @item set print address off
4959 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4960 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4961
4962 @smallexample
4963 @group
4964 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4965 (@value{GDBP}) f
4966 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4967 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4968 @end group
4969 @end smallexample
4970
4971 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4972 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4973 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4974 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4975
4976 @kindex show print address
4977 @item show print address
4978 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4979 @end table
4980
4981 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4982 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4983 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4984 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4985 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4986 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4987 it prints a symbolic address:
4988
4989 @table @code
4990 @kindex set print symbol-filename
4991 @item set print symbol-filename on
4992 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4993 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4994
4995 @item set print symbol-filename off
4996 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4997 default.
4998
4999 @kindex show print symbol-filename
5000 @item show print symbol-filename
5001 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5002 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5003 @end table
5004
5005 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5006 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5007 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5008
5009 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5010 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5011
5012 @table @code
5013 @kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5014 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5015 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5016 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5017 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
5018 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5019
5020 @kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5021 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
5022 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5023 symbolic address.
5024 @end table
5025
5026 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5027 @cindex pointer, finding referent
5028 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5029 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5030 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5031 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5032 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5033 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5034
5035 @example
5036 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5037 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5038 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5039 @end example
5040
5041 @quotation
5042 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5043 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5044 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5045 @end quotation
5046
5047 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5048
5049 @table @code
5050 @kindex set print array
5051 @item set print array
5052 @itemx set print array on
5053 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5054 but uses more space. The default is off.
5055
5056 @item set print array off
5057 Return to compressed format for arrays.
5058
5059 @kindex show print array
5060 @item show print array
5061 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5062 arrays.
5063
5064 @kindex set print elements
5065 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5066 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5067 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5068 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5069 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5070 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5071 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5072
5073 @kindex show print elements
5074 @item show print elements
5075 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5076 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5077
5078 @kindex set print null-stop
5079 @item set print null-stop
5080 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5081 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
5082 contain only short strings.
5083 The default is off.
5084
5085 @kindex set print pretty
5086 @item set print pretty on
5087 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5088 per line, like this:
5089
5090 @smallexample
5091 @group
5092 $1 = @{
5093 next = 0x0,
5094 flags = @{
5095 sweet = 1,
5096 sour = 1
5097 @},
5098 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5099 @}
5100 @end group
5101 @end smallexample
5102
5103 @item set print pretty off
5104 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5105
5106 @smallexample
5107 @group
5108 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5109 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5110 @end group
5111 @end smallexample
5112
5113 @noindent
5114 This is the default format.
5115
5116 @kindex show print pretty
5117 @item show print pretty
5118 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5119
5120 @kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5121 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
5122 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5123 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5124 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5125 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5126 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5127
5128 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
5129 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5130 international character sets, and is the default.
5131
5132 @kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5133 @item show print sevenbit-strings
5134 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5135
5136 @kindex set print union
5137 @item set print union on
5138 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
5139 is the default setting.
5140
5141 @item set print union off
5142 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5143
5144 @kindex show print union
5145 @item show print union
5146 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5147 structures.
5148
5149 For example, given the declarations
5150
5151 @smallexample
5152 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5153 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5154 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5155 Bug_forms;
5156
5157 struct thing @{
5158 Species it;
5159 union @{
5160 Tree_forms tree;
5161 Bug_forms bug;
5162 @} form;
5163 @};
5164
5165 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5166 @end smallexample
5167
5168 @noindent
5169 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5170
5171 @smallexample
5172 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5173 @end smallexample
5174
5175 @noindent
5176 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5177
5178 @smallexample
5179 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5180 @end smallexample
5181 @end table
5182
5183 @need 1000
5184 @noindent
5185 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
5186
5187 @table @code
5188 @cindex demangling
5189 @kindex set print demangle
5190 @item set print demangle
5191 @itemx set print demangle on
5192 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5193 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
5194 linkage. The default is on.
5195
5196 @kindex show print demangle
5197 @item show print demangle
5198 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5199
5200 @kindex set print asm-demangle
5201 @item set print asm-demangle
5202 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
5203 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5204 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5205 The default is off.
5206
5207 @kindex show print asm-demangle
5208 @item show print asm-demangle
5209 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5210 or demangled form.
5211
5212 @kindex set demangle-style
5213 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5214 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
5215 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
5216 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5217 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5218
5219 @table @code
5220 @item auto
5221 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5222
5223 @item gnu
5224 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
5225 This is the default.
5226
5227 @item hp
5228 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5229
5230 @item lucid
5231 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5232
5233 @item arm
5234 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
5235 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5236 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5237 require further enhancement to permit that.
5238
5239 @end table
5240 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5241
5242 @kindex show demangle-style
5243 @item show demangle-style
5244 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
5245
5246 @kindex set print object
5247 @item set print object
5248 @itemx set print object on
5249 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5250 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5251 the virtual function table.
5252
5253 @item set print object off
5254 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5255 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5256
5257 @kindex show print object
5258 @item show print object
5259 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5260
5261 @kindex set print static-members
5262 @item set print static-members
5263 @itemx set print static-members on
5264 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
5265
5266 @item set print static-members off
5267 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
5268
5269 @kindex show print static-members
5270 @item show print static-members
5271 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
5272
5273 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5274 @kindex set print vtbl
5275 @item set print vtbl
5276 @itemx set print vtbl on
5277 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
5278 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5279 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
5280
5281 @item set print vtbl off
5282 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
5283
5284 @kindex show print vtbl
5285 @item show print vtbl
5286 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5287 @end table
5288
5289 @node Value History
5290 @section Value history
5291
5292 @cindex value history
5293 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5294 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5295 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5296 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5297 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5298 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5299 symbol table.
5300
5301 @cindex @code{$}
5302 @cindex @code{$$}
5303 @cindex history number
5304 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5305 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5306 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5307 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5308 history number.
5309
5310 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5311 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5312 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5313 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5314 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5315 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5316 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5317
5318 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5319 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5320
5321 @example
5322 p *$
5323 @end example
5324
5325 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5326 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5327
5328 @example
5329 p *$.next
5330 @end example
5331
5332 @noindent
5333 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5334 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5335
5336 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5337 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5338
5339 @example
5340 print x
5341 set x=5
5342 @end example
5343
5344 @noindent
5345 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5346 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5347
5348 @table @code
5349 @kindex show values
5350 @item show values
5351 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5352 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5353 values} does not change the history.
5354
5355 @item show values @var{n}
5356 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5357
5358 @item show values +
5359 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5360 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5361 @end table
5362
5363 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5364 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5365
5366 @node Convenience Vars
5367 @section Convenience variables
5368
5369 @cindex convenience variables
5370 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5371 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5372 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5373 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5374 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5375
5376 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5377 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
5378 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5379 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5380 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5381
5382 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5383 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5384 For example:
5385
5386 @example
5387 set $foo = *object_ptr
5388 @end example
5389
5390 @noindent
5391 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5392 @code{object_ptr}.
5393
5394 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5395 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5396 value with another assignment at any time.
5397
5398 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5399 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5400 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5401 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5402
5403 @table @code
5404 @kindex show convenience
5405 @item show convenience
5406 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
5407 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
5408 @end table
5409
5410 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5411 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5412 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5413
5414 @example
5415 set $i = 0
5416 print bar[$i++]->contents
5417 @end example
5418
5419 @noindent
5420 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
5421
5422 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5423 values likely to be useful.
5424
5425 @table @code
5426 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
5427 @item $_
5428 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5429 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5430 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5431 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5432 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5433 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5434 to the type of @code{$__}.
5435
5436 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
5437 @item $__
5438 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5439 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5440 to match the format in which the data was printed.
5441
5442 @item $_exitcode
5443 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
5444 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5445 the program being debugged terminates.
5446 @end table
5447
5448 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5449 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5450 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
5451
5452 @node Registers
5453 @section Registers
5454
5455 @cindex registers
5456 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5457 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5458 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5459 your machine.
5460
5461 @table @code
5462 @kindex info registers
5463 @item info registers
5464 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5465 registers (in the selected stack frame).
5466
5467 @kindex info all-registers
5468 @cindex floating point registers
5469 @item info all-registers
5470 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5471 registers.
5472
5473 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5474 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5475 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5476 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5477 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5478 @end table
5479
5480 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5481 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5482 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5483 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5484 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5485 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5486 register that contains the processor status. For example,
5487 you could print the program counter in hex with
5488
5489 @example
5490 p/x $pc
5491 @end example
5492
5493 @noindent
5494 or print the instruction to be executed next with
5495
5496 @example
5497 x/i $pc
5498 @end example
5499
5500 @noindent
5501 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5502 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5503 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5504 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5505 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5506 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
5507 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
5508
5509 @example
5510 set $sp += 4
5511 @end example
5512
5513 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5514 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5515 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5516 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5517 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
5518 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5519 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
5520
5521 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5522 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5523 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5524 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5525 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5526 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5527 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5528
5529 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5530 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5531 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5532 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5533 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5534 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5535 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5536 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5537 prints the data in both formats.
5538
5539 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5540 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5541 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5542 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5543 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5544 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5545
5546 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5547 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5548 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5549 frame makes no difference.
5550
5551 @node Floating Point Hardware
5552 @section Floating point hardware
5553 @cindex floating point
5554
5555 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5556 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5557
5558 @table @code
5559 @kindex info float
5560 @item info float
5561 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5562 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5563 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5564 the ARM and x86 machines.
5565 @end table
5566
5567 @node Memory Region Attributes
5568 @section Memory Region Attributes
5569 @cindex memory region attributes
5570
5571 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5572 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5573 to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5574 use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5575
5576 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5577 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5578 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5579 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5580 all memory.
5581
5582 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5583 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5584
5585 @table @code
5586 @kindex mem
5587 @item mem @var{address1} @var{address2} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5588 Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5589 with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5590
5591 @kindex delete mem
5592 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5593 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5594
5595 @kindex disable mem
5596 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5597 Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5598 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5599 It may be enabled again later.
5600
5601 @kindex enable mem
5602 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5603 Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5604
5605 @kindex info mem
5606 @item info mem
5607 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5608 for each region.
5609
5610 @table @emph
5611 @item Memory Region Number
5612 @item Enabled or Disabled.
5613 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5614 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5615
5616 @item Lo Address
5617 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5618
5619 @item Hi Address
5620 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5621
5622 @item Attributes
5623 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5624 @end table
5625 @end table
5626
5627
5628 @subsection Attributes
5629
5630 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5631 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5632 write accesses to a memory region.
5633
5634 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5635 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5636 etc. from accessing memory.
5637
5638 @table @code
5639 @item ro
5640 Memory is read only.
5641 @item wo
5642 Memory is write only.
5643 @item rw
5644 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
5645 @end table
5646
5647 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
5648 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5649 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5650 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5651 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5652
5653 @table @code
5654 @item 8
5655 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5656 @item 16
5657 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5658 @item 32
5659 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5660 @item 64
5661 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5662 @end table
5663
5664 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5665 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5666 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5667 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5668 @c
5669 @c @table @code
5670 @c @item hwbreak
5671 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
5672 @c @item swbreak (default)
5673 @c @end table
5674
5675 @subsubsection Data Cache
5676 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5677 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5678 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5679 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5680 registers.
5681
5682 @table @code
5683 @item cache
5684 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5685 @item nocache
5686 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
5687 @end table
5688
5689 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5690 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5691 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5692 @c
5693 @c @table @code
5694 @c @item verify
5695 @c @item noverify (default)
5696 @c @end table
5697
5698 @node Tracepoints
5699 @chapter Tracepoints
5700 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
5701 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
5702
5703 @cindex tracepoints
5704 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
5705 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
5706 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
5707 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
5708 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
5709 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
5710 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
5711
5712 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
5713 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
5714 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
5715 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
5716 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
5717 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
5718 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
5719 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
5720 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
5721 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
5722 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
5723
5724 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
5725 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
5726 to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
5727 stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
5728 tracepoints as of this writing.
5729
5730 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
5731
5732 @menu
5733 * Set Tracepoints::
5734 * Analyze Collected Data::
5735 * Tracepoint Variables::
5736 @end menu
5737
5738 @node Set Tracepoints
5739 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
5740
5741 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
5742 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
5743 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
5744 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
5745 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
5746 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
5747 work on.
5748
5749 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
5750 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
5751 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
5752 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
5753 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
5754 tracepoint was hit.
5755
5756 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
5757 conditions and actions.
5758
5759 @menu
5760 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
5761 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
5762 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
5763 * Tracepoint Actions::
5764 * Listing Tracepoints::
5765 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
5766 @end menu
5767
5768 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
5769 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
5770
5771 @table @code
5772 @cindex set tracepoint
5773 @kindex trace
5774 @item trace
5775 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
5776 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
5777 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
5778 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
5779 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
5780 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
5781 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
5782 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
5783 running.
5784
5785 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
5786
5787 @smallexample
5788 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
5789
5790 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
5791
5792 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
5793
5794 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
5795
5796 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
5797 @end smallexample
5798
5799 @noindent
5800 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
5801
5802 @vindex $tpnum
5803 @cindex last tracepoint number
5804 @cindex recent tracepoint number
5805 @cindex tracepoint number
5806 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
5807 of the most recently set tracepoint.
5808
5809 @kindex delete tracepoint
5810 @cindex tracepoint deletion
5811 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5812 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
5813 default is to delete all tracepoints.
5814
5815 Examples:
5816
5817 @smallexample
5818 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
5819
5820 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
5821 @end smallexample
5822
5823 @noindent
5824 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
5825 @end table
5826
5827 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5828 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5829
5830 @table @code
5831 @kindex disable tracepoint
5832 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5833 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
5834 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
5835 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
5836 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
5837
5838 @kindex enable tracepoint
5839 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5840 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
5841 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
5842 run.
5843 @end table
5844
5845 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
5846 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
5847
5848 @table @code
5849 @kindex passcount
5850 @cindex tracepoint pass count
5851 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
5852 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
5853 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
5854 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
5855 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
5856 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
5857 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
5858 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
5859 user.
5860
5861 Examples:
5862
5863 @smallexample
5864 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
5865 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
5866
5867 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
5868 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
5869 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5870 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
5871 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
5872 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
5873 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
5874 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
5875 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
5876 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
5877 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
5878 @end smallexample
5879 @end table
5880
5881 @node Tracepoint Actions
5882 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
5883
5884 @table @code
5885 @kindex actions
5886 @cindex tracepoint actions
5887 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5888 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
5889 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
5890 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
5891 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
5892 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
5893 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
5894 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
5895 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
5896 @code{while-stepping}.
5897
5898 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
5899 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
5900 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
5901
5902 @smallexample
5903 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
5904
5905 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
5906
5907 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
5908 @end smallexample
5909
5910 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
5911 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
5912 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
5913 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
5914 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
5915 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
5916 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
5917 @code{end} command.
5918
5919 @smallexample
5920 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5921 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
5922 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
5923 > collect bar,baz
5924 > collect $regs
5925 > while-stepping 12
5926 > collect $fp, $sp
5927 > end
5928 end
5929 @end smallexample
5930
5931 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
5932 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
5933 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
5934 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
5935 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
5936 special arguments are supported:
5937
5938 @table @code
5939 @item $regs
5940 collect all registers
5941
5942 @item $args
5943 collect all function arguments
5944
5945 @item $locals
5946 collect all local variables.
5947 @end table
5948
5949 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
5950 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
5951 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
5952
5953 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
5954 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
5955
5956 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
5957 @item while-stepping @var{n}
5958 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
5959 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
5960 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
5961 its own @code{end} command):
5962
5963 @smallexample
5964 > while-stepping 12
5965 > collect $regs, myglobal
5966 > end
5967 >
5968 @end smallexample
5969
5970 @noindent
5971 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
5972 @code{stepping}.
5973 @end table
5974
5975 @node Listing Tracepoints
5976 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
5977
5978 @table @code
5979 @kindex info tracepoints
5980 @cindex information about tracepoints
5981 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5982 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
5983 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
5984 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
5985 shown:
5986
5987 @itemize @bullet
5988 @item
5989 its number
5990 @item
5991 whether it is enabled or disabled
5992 @item
5993 its address
5994 @item
5995 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
5996 @item
5997 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
5998 @item
5999 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6000 @item
6001 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6002 @end itemize
6003
6004 @smallexample
6005 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6006 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
6007 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6008 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
6009 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
6010 (@value{GDBP})
6011 @end smallexample
6012
6013 @noindent
6014 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6015 @end table
6016
6017 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6018 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6019
6020 @table @code
6021 @kindex tstart
6022 @cindex start a new trace experiment
6023 @cindex collected data discarded
6024 @item tstart
6025 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6026 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6027 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6028 experiment.
6029
6030 @kindex tstop
6031 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
6032 @item tstop
6033 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6034 stops collecting data.
6035
6036 @strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6037 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6038 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6039
6040 @kindex tstatus
6041 @cindex status of trace data collection
6042 @cindex trace experiment, status of
6043 @item tstatus
6044 This command displays the status of the current trace data
6045 collection.
6046 @end table
6047
6048 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6049
6050 @smallexample
6051 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6052 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6053 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6054 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
6055 > while-stepping 11
6056 > collect $regs
6057 > end
6058 > end
6059 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6060 [time passes @dots{}]
6061 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6062 @end smallexample
6063
6064
6065 @node Analyze Collected Data
6066 @section Using the collected data
6067
6068 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6069 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6070 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6071 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6072 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6073 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6074 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6075 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6076 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6077 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6078 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6079 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6080 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6081 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6082 the buffer will fail.
6083
6084 @menu
6085 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6086 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6087 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6088 @end menu
6089
6090 @node tfind
6091 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6092
6093 @kindex tfind
6094 @cindex select trace snapshot
6095 @cindex find trace snapshot
6096 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6097 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6098 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6099 snapshot is selected.
6100
6101 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6102
6103 @table @code
6104 @item tfind start
6105 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6106 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6107
6108 @item tfind none
6109 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6110
6111 @item tfind end
6112 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6113
6114 @item tfind
6115 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6116
6117 @item tfind -
6118 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6119 retracing earlier steps.
6120
6121 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6122 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6123 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6124 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6125 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6126
6127 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
6128 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6129 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6130 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6131 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6132
6133 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6134 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6135 addresses.
6136
6137 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6138 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6139 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6140
6141 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6142 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6143 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6144 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6145 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6146 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6147 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6148 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6149 @end table
6150
6151 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6152 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6153 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6154 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6155 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6156 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6157 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6158 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6159 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6160 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6161 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6162 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6163 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6164 tracepoint as the current one.
6165
6166 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6167 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6168 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6169 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6170 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6171
6172 @smallexample
6173 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6174 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6175 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6176 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6177 > tfind
6178 > end
6179
6180 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6181 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6182 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6183 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6184 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6185 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6186 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6187 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6188 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6189 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6190 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6191 @end smallexample
6192
6193 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6194 the buffer:
6195
6196 @smallexample
6197 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6198 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6199 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6200 > tfind line
6201 > end
6202
6203 Frame 0, X = 1
6204 Frame 7, X = 2
6205 Frame 13, X = 255
6206 @end smallexample
6207
6208 @node tdump
6209 @subsection @code{tdump}
6210 @kindex tdump
6211 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6212 @cindex tracepoint data, display
6213
6214 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6215 the current trace snapshot.
6216
6217 @smallexample
6218 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6219 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6220 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6221 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6222 > end
6223
6224 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6225
6226 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6227 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6228 at gdb_test.c:444
6229 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6230
6231 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6232 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6233 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6234 d1 0x18 24
6235 d2 0x80 128
6236 d3 0x33 51
6237 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6238 d5 0x22 34
6239 d6 0xe0 224
6240 d7 0x380035 3670069
6241 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6242 a1 0x3000668 50333288
6243 a2 0x100 256
6244 a3 0x322000 3284992
6245 a4 0x3000698 50333336
6246 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6247 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6248 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6249 ps 0x0 0
6250 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6251 fpcontrol 0x0 0
6252 fpstatus 0x0 0
6253 fpiaddr 0x0 0
6254 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6255 p1 = (void *) 0x11
6256 p2 = (void *) 0x22
6257 p3 = (void *) 0x33
6258 p4 = (void *) 0x44
6259 p5 = (void *) 0x55
6260 p6 = (void *) 0x66
6261 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6262
6263 (@value{GDBP})
6264 @end smallexample
6265
6266 @node save-tracepoints
6267 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6268 @kindex save-tracepoints
6269 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6270
6271 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6272 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6273 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6274 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6275 Files}).
6276
6277 @node Tracepoint Variables
6278 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6279 @cindex tracepoint variables
6280 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6281
6282 @table @code
6283 @vindex $trace_frame
6284 @item (int) $trace_frame
6285 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6286 snapshot is selected.
6287
6288 @vindex $tracepoint
6289 @item (int) $tracepoint
6290 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6291
6292 @vindex $trace_line
6293 @item (int) $trace_line
6294 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6295
6296 @vindex $trace_file
6297 @item (char []) $trace_file
6298 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6299
6300 @vindex $trace_func
6301 @item (char []) $trace_func
6302 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6303 @end table
6304
6305 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6306 use @code{output} instead.
6307
6308 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6309 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6310 data.
6311
6312 @smallexample
6313 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6314
6315 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6316 > output $trace_file
6317 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6318 > tfind
6319 > end
6320 @end smallexample
6321
6322 @node Overlays
6323 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
6324 @cindex overlays
6325
6326 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
6327 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
6328 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
6329 use overlays.
6330
6331 @menu
6332 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
6333 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
6334 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
6335 mapped by asking the inferior.
6336 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
6337 @end menu
6338
6339 @node How Overlays Work
6340 @section How Overlays Work
6341 @cindex mapped overlays
6342 @cindex unmapped overlays
6343 @cindex load address, overlay's
6344 @cindex mapped address
6345 @cindex overlay area
6346
6347 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
6348 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
6349 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
6350 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
6351 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
6352
6353 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
6354 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
6355 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
6356 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
6357 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
6358 largest overlay as well.
6359
6360 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
6361 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
6362 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
6363 there.
6364
6365 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
6366 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
6367 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
6368
6369 @example
6370 @group
6371 Data Instruction Larger
6372 Address Space Address Space Address Space
6373 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
6374 | | | | | |
6375 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
6376 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
6377 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
6378 | and heap | | | | | |
6379 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
6380 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
6381 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
6382 | | | | | |
6383 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
6384 address | | | | | |
6385 | overlay | <-' | | |
6386 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
6387 | | <---. | | load address
6388 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
6389 | | | |
6390 +-----------+ | |
6391 +-----------+
6392 | |
6393 +-----------+
6394
6395 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
6396 @end group
6397 @end example
6398
6399 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
6400 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
6401 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
6402 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
6403 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
6404 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
6405 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
6406 program and the overlay area.
6407
6408 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
6409 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
6410 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
6411 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
6412 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
6413 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
6414 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
6415
6416 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
6417 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
6418 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
6419
6420 @itemize @bullet
6421
6422 @item
6423 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
6424 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
6425 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
6426 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
6427
6428 @item
6429 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
6430 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
6431 your program's performance.
6432
6433 @item
6434 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
6435 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
6436 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
6437 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
6438 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
6439 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
6440 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
6441
6442 @item
6443 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
6444 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
6445 instruction and data spaces.
6446
6447 @end itemize
6448
6449 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
6450 improved in many ways:
6451
6452 @itemize @bullet
6453
6454 @item
6455 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
6456 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
6457 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
6458 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
6459 area in the usual way.
6460
6461 @item
6462 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
6463 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
6464
6465 @item
6466 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
6467 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
6468 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
6469 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
6470 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
6471 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
6472 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
6473
6474 @end itemize
6475
6476
6477 @node Overlay Commands
6478 @section Overlay Commands
6479
6480 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
6481 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
6482 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
6483 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
6484 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
6485 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
6486
6487 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
6488 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
6489
6490 @table @code
6491 @item overlay off
6492 @kindex overlay off
6493 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
6494 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
6495 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
6496 overlay support is disabled.
6497
6498 @item overlay manual
6499 @kindex overlay manual
6500 @cindex manual overlay debugging
6501 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
6502 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
6503 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
6504 commands described below.
6505
6506 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
6507 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
6508 @kindex overlay map-overlay
6509 @cindex map an overlay
6510 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
6511 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
6512 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
6513 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
6514 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
6515 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
6516
6517 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
6518 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
6519 @kindex overlay unmap-overlay
6520 @cindex unmap an overlay
6521 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
6522 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
6523 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
6524 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
6525
6526 @item overlay auto
6527 @kindex overlay auto
6528 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
6529 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
6530 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
6531 Overlay Debugging}.
6532
6533 @item overlay load-target
6534 @itemx overlay load
6535 @kindex overlay load-target
6536 @cindex reloading the overlay table
6537 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
6538 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
6539 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
6540 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
6541 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
6542
6543 @item overlay list-overlays
6544 @itemx overlay list
6545 @cindex listing mapped overlays
6546 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
6547 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
6548
6549 @end table
6550
6551 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
6552 of the function the address falls in:
6553
6554 @example
6555 (gdb) print main
6556 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
6557 @end example
6558 @noindent
6559 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
6560 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
6561 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
6562 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
6563
6564 @example
6565 (gdb) overlay list
6566 No sections are mapped.
6567 (gdb) print foo
6568 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
6569 @end example
6570 @noindent
6571 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
6572 name normally:
6573
6574 @example
6575 (gdb) overlay list
6576 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
6577 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
6578 (gdb) print foo
6579 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
6580 @end example
6581
6582 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
6583 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
6584 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
6585 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
6586 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
6587
6588 @itemize @bullet
6589 @item
6590 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
6591 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
6592 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
6593 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
6594 @item
6595 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
6596 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
6597 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
6598 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
6599 breakpoints properly.
6600 @end itemize
6601
6602
6603 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
6604 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
6605 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
6606
6607 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
6608 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
6609 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
6610 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
6611 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
6612 current state of the overlays.
6613
6614 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
6615 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
6616
6617 @table @asis
6618
6619 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
6620 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
6621
6622 @example
6623 struct
6624 @{
6625 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
6626 unsigned long vma;
6627
6628 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
6629 unsigned long size;
6630
6631 /* The overlay's load address. */
6632 unsigned long lma;
6633
6634 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
6635 zero otherwise. */
6636 unsigned long mapped;
6637 @}
6638 @end example
6639
6640 @item @code{_novlys}:
6641 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
6642 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
6643
6644 @end table
6645
6646 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
6647 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
6648 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
6649 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
6650 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
6651 currently mapped.
6652
6653 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
6654 @var{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
6655 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
6656 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
6657 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
6658 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
6659 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
6660 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
6661 are not being executed.
6662
6663 @node Overlay Sample Program
6664 @section Overlay Sample Program
6665 @cindex overlay example program
6666
6667 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
6668 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
6669 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
6670 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
6671 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
6672 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
6673 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
6674
6675 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
6676 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
6677 suite. The program consists of the following files from
6678 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
6679
6680 @table @file
6681 @item overlays.c
6682 The main program file.
6683 @item ovlymgr.c
6684 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
6685 @item foo.c
6686 @itemx bar.c
6687 @itemx baz.c
6688 @itemx grbx.c
6689 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
6690 @item d10v.ld
6691 @itemx m32r.ld
6692 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
6693 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
6694 @end table
6695
6696 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
6697 cross-compiler like this:
6698
6699 @example
6700 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
6701 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
6702 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
6703 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
6704 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
6705 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
6706 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
6707 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
6708 @end example
6709
6710 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
6711 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
6712 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
6713
6714
6715 @node Languages
6716 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
6717 @cindex languages
6718
6719 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
6720 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
6721 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
6722 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
6723 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
6724 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
6725
6726 @cindex working language
6727 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
6728 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
6729 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
6730 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
6731 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
6732 language}.
6733
6734 @menu
6735 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
6736 * Show:: Displaying the language
6737 * Checks:: Type and range checks
6738 * Support:: Supported languages
6739 @end menu
6740
6741 @node Setting
6742 @section Switching between source languages
6743
6744 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
6745 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
6746 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
6747 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
6748 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
6749 are printed, etc.
6750
6751 In addition to the working language, every source file that
6752 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
6753 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
6754 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
6755 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
6756 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
6757 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
6758 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
6759 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
6760 Displaying the language}.
6761
6762 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
6763 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
6764 another language. In that case, make the
6765 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
6766 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
6767 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
6768
6769 @menu
6770 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
6771 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
6772 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6773 @end menu
6774
6775 @node Filenames
6776 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
6777
6778 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
6779 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
6780
6781 @table @file
6782
6783 @item .c
6784 C source file
6785
6786 @item .C
6787 @itemx .cc
6788 @itemx .cp
6789 @itemx .cpp
6790 @itemx .cxx
6791 @itemx .c++
6792 C@t{++} source file
6793
6794 @item .f
6795 @itemx .F
6796 Fortran source file
6797
6798 @item .ch
6799 @itemx .c186
6800 @itemx .c286
6801 CHILL source file
6802
6803 @item .mod
6804 Modula-2 source file
6805
6806 @item .s
6807 @itemx .S
6808 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
6809 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
6810 @end table
6811
6812 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
6813 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
6814
6815 @node Manually
6816 @subsection Setting the working language
6817
6818 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
6819 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
6820 your program.
6821
6822 @kindex set language
6823 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
6824 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
6825 a language, such as
6826 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
6827 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
6828
6829 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
6830 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
6831 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
6832 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
6833 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
6834 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
6835 command such as:
6836
6837 @example
6838 print a = b + c
6839 @end example
6840
6841 @noindent
6842 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
6843 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
6844 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
6845 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
6846
6847 @node Automatically
6848 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6849
6850 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
6851 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
6852 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
6853 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
6854 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
6855 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
6856 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
6857 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
6858 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
6859
6860 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
6861 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
6862 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
6863 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
6864 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
6865
6866 @node Show
6867 @section Displaying the language
6868
6869 The following commands help you find out which language is the
6870 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
6871
6872 @kindex show language
6873 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
6874 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
6875 @table @code
6876 @item show language
6877 Display the current working language. This is the
6878 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
6879 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
6880
6881 @item info frame
6882 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
6883 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
6884 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
6885 information listed here.
6886
6887 @item info source
6888 Display the source language of this source file.
6889 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
6890 information listed here.
6891 @end table
6892
6893 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
6894 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
6895 with a language explicitly:
6896
6897 @kindex set extension-language
6898 @kindex info extensions
6899 @table @code
6900 @item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
6901 Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
6902 the source language @var{language}.
6903
6904 @item info extensions
6905 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
6906 @end table
6907
6908 @node Checks
6909 @section Type and range checking
6910
6911 @quotation
6912 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
6913 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
6914 section documents the intended facilities.
6915 @end quotation
6916 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
6917
6918 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
6919 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
6920 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
6921 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
6922 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
6923 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
6924 errors when your program is running.
6925
6926 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
6927 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
6928 can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
6929 the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
6930 @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
6931 your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
6932 for the default settings of supported languages.
6933
6934 @menu
6935 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
6936 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
6937 @end menu
6938
6939 @cindex type checking
6940 @cindex checks, type
6941 @node Type Checking
6942 @subsection An overview of type checking
6943
6944 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
6945 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
6946 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
6947 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
6948
6949 @smallexample
6950 1 + 2 @result{} 3
6951 @exdent but
6952 @error{} 1 + 2.3
6953 @end smallexample
6954
6955 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
6956 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
6957
6958 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
6959 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
6960 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
6961 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
6962 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
6963 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
6964 also issues a warning.
6965
6966 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
6967 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
6968 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
6969 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
6970 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
6971 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
6972
6973 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
6974 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
6975 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
6976 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
6977 operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
6978 details on specific languages.
6979
6980 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
6981
6982 @kindex set check@r{, type}
6983 @kindex set check type
6984 @kindex show check type
6985 @table @code
6986 @item set check type auto
6987 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
6988 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6989 each language.
6990
6991 @item set check type on
6992 @itemx set check type off
6993 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6994 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
6995 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
6996 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
6997 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
6998
6999 @item set check type warn
7000 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7001 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7002 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7003 numbers and structures.
7004
7005 @item show type
7006 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
7007 is setting it automatically.
7008 @end table
7009
7010 @cindex range checking
7011 @cindex checks, range
7012 @node Range Checking
7013 @subsection An overview of range checking
7014
7015 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7016 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7017 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7018 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7019 not exceed the bounds of the array.
7020
7021 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7022 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7023 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7024 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7025
7026 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7027 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7028 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7029 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7030 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7031 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7032
7033 @example
7034 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
7035 @end example
7036
7037 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7038 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7039 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7040
7041 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7042
7043 @kindex set check@r{, range}
7044 @kindex set check range
7045 @kindex show check range
7046 @table @code
7047 @item set check range auto
7048 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7049 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7050 each language.
7051
7052 @item set check range on
7053 @itemx set check range off
7054 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7055 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
7056 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7057 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
7058
7059 @item set check range warn
7060 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7061 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7062 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7063 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7064 systems).
7065
7066 @item show range
7067 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7068 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7069 @end table
7070
7071 @node Support
7072 @section Supported languages
7073
7074 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
7075 @c This is false ...
7076 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7077 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7078 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7079 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7080 language.
7081
7082 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7083 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7084 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7085 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7086 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7087 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7088 language reference or tutorial.
7089
7090 @menu
7091 * C:: C and C@t{++}
7092 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
7093 * Chill:: Chill
7094 @end menu
7095
7096 @node C
7097 @subsection C and C@t{++}
7098
7099 @cindex C and C@t{++}
7100 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
7101
7102 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
7103 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7104 together.
7105
7106 @cindex C@t{++}
7107 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
7108 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7109 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7110 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7111 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7112 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
7113 compiler (@code{aCC}).
7114
7115 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
7116 format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
7117 command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
7118 @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7119 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
7120
7121 @menu
7122 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7123 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7124 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7125 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7126 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7127 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
7128 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
7129 @end menu
7130
7131 @node C Operators
7132 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7133
7134 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
7135
7136 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7137 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7138 often defined on groups of types.
7139
7140 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
7141
7142 @itemize @bullet
7143
7144 @item
7145 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
7146 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
7147
7148 @item
7149 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7150 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
7151
7152 @item
7153 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
7154
7155 @item
7156 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
7157
7158 @end itemize
7159
7160 @noindent
7161 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7162 in order of increasing precedence:
7163
7164 @table @code
7165 @item ,
7166 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7167 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7168 expression being the last expression evaluated.
7169
7170 @item =
7171 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7172 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7173
7174 @item @var{op}=
7175 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7176 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
7177 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
7178 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7179 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7180
7181 @item ?:
7182 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7183 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7184 integral type.
7185
7186 @item ||
7187 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7188
7189 @item &&
7190 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7191
7192 @item |
7193 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7194
7195 @item ^
7196 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7197
7198 @item &
7199 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7200
7201 @item ==@r{, }!=
7202 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7203 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7204
7205 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7206 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7207 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7208 and non-zero for true.
7209
7210 @item <<@r{, }>>
7211 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7212
7213 @item @@
7214 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7215
7216 @item +@r{, }-
7217 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7218 pointer types.
7219
7220 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7221 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7222 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7223 integral types.
7224
7225 @item ++@r{, }--
7226 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7227 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7228 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7229 operation takes place.
7230
7231 @item *
7232 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7233 @code{++}.
7234
7235 @item &
7236 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7237
7238 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7239 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
7240 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
7241 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
7242 stored.
7243
7244 @item -
7245 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7246 precedence as @code{++}.
7247
7248 @item !
7249 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7250 @code{++}.
7251
7252 @item ~
7253 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7254 @code{++}.
7255
7256
7257 @item .@r{, }->
7258 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7259 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7260 pointer based on the stored type information.
7261 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7262
7263 @item .*@r{, }->*
7264 Dereferences of pointers to members.
7265
7266 @item []
7267 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7268 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7269
7270 @item ()
7271 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7272
7273 @item ::
7274 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7275 and @code{class} types.
7276
7277 @item ::
7278 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7279 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7280 above.
7281 @end table
7282
7283 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7284 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7285 predefined meaning.
7286
7287 @menu
7288 * C Constants::
7289 @end menu
7290
7291 @node C Constants
7292 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
7293
7294 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
7295
7296 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
7297 following ways:
7298
7299 @itemize @bullet
7300 @item
7301 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
7302 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
7303 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
7304 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
7305 @code{long} value.
7306
7307 @item
7308 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
7309 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
7310 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
7311 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
7312 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
7313 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
7314 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
7315 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
7316 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
7317 constant.
7318
7319 @item
7320 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
7321 integral equivalents.
7322
7323 @item
7324 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
7325 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
7326 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
7327 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
7328 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
7329 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
7330 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
7331 @samp{\n} for newline.
7332
7333 @item
7334 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
7335 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
7336 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
7337 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
7338 characters.
7339
7340 @item
7341 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
7342 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
7343
7344 @item
7345 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
7346 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
7347 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
7348 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
7349 @end itemize
7350
7351 @menu
7352 * C plus plus expressions::
7353 * C Defaults::
7354 * C Checks::
7355
7356 * Debugging C::
7357 @end menu
7358
7359 @node C plus plus expressions
7360 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
7361
7362 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
7363 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
7364
7365 @cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
7366 @cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
7367 @cindex C@t{++} and object formats
7368 @cindex object formats and C@t{++}
7369 @cindex a.out and C@t{++}
7370 @cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
7371 @cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
7372 @cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
7373 @cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
7374 @c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
7375 @c periodically whether this has happened...
7376 @quotation
7377 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
7378 proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
7379 additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
7380 special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
7381 @sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
7382 symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
7383 you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
7384 extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
7385 @sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
7386 support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
7387 @end quotation
7388
7389 @enumerate
7390
7391 @cindex member functions
7392 @item
7393 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
7394
7395 @example
7396 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
7397 @end example
7398
7399 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
7400 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
7401 @item
7402 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
7403 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
7404 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
7405 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
7406
7407 @cindex call overloaded functions
7408 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
7409 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
7410 @item
7411 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
7412 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
7413 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
7414 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
7415 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
7416 default arguments.
7417
7418 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
7419 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
7420 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
7421 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
7422 number of function arguments.
7423
7424 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
7425 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
7426 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
7427
7428 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
7429 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
7430 @smallexample
7431 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
7432 @end smallexample
7433
7434 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
7435 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
7436
7437 @cindex reference declarations
7438 @item
7439 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
7440 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
7441 dereferenced.
7442
7443 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
7444 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
7445 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
7446 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
7447 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
7448
7449 @item
7450 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
7451 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
7452 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
7453 necessary, for example in an expression like
7454 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
7455 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
7456 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
7457 @end enumerate
7458
7459 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
7460 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
7461 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
7462 invoking user-defined operators.
7463
7464 @node C Defaults
7465 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7466
7467 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
7468
7469 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
7470 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
7471 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
7472 selects the working language.
7473
7474 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
7475 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
7476 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
7477 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
7478 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
7479 for further details.
7480
7481 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
7482 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
7483 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7484
7485 @node C Checks
7486 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7487
7488 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
7489
7490 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
7491 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
7492 considers two variables type equivalent if:
7493
7494 @itemize @bullet
7495 @item
7496 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
7497 enumerated tag.
7498
7499 @item
7500 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
7501 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
7502
7503 @ignore
7504 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
7505 @c FIXME--beers?
7506 @item
7507 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
7508 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
7509 compilers.)
7510 @end ignore
7511 @end itemize
7512
7513 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
7514 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
7515 that is not itself an array.
7516
7517 @node Debugging C
7518 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
7519
7520 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
7521 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7522 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
7523 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
7524
7525 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
7526 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
7527 ,Expressions}.
7528
7529 @menu
7530 * Debugging C plus plus::
7531 @end menu
7532
7533 @node Debugging C plus plus
7534 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
7535
7536 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
7537
7538 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
7539 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
7540
7541 @table @code
7542 @cindex break in overloaded functions
7543 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
7544 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
7545 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
7546 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
7547
7548 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
7549 @item rbreak @var{regex}
7550 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
7551 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
7552 classes.
7553 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
7554
7555 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
7556 @item catch throw
7557 @itemx catch catch
7558 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
7559 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
7560
7561 @cindex inheritance
7562 @item ptype @var{typename}
7563 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
7564 @var{typename}.
7565 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
7566
7567 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
7568 @item set print demangle
7569 @itemx show print demangle
7570 @itemx set print asm-demangle
7571 @itemx show print asm-demangle
7572 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
7573 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
7574 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7575
7576 @item set print object
7577 @itemx show print object
7578 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
7579 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7580
7581 @item set print vtbl
7582 @itemx show print vtbl
7583 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
7584 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7585 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7586 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7587
7588 @kindex set overload-resolution
7589 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
7590 @item set overload-resolution on
7591 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
7592 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
7593 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
7594 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
7595 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
7596 message.
7597
7598 @item set overload-resolution off
7599 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
7600 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7601 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
7602 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
7603 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7604 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
7605 argument types.
7606
7607 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
7608 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
7609 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
7610 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
7611 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
7612 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
7613 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
7614 @end table
7615
7616 @node Modula-2
7617 @subsection Modula-2
7618
7619 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
7620
7621 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
7622 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
7623 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
7624 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
7625 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7626 table.
7627
7628 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
7629 @menu
7630 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
7631 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
7632 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
7633 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
7634 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
7635 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
7636 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7637 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7638 @end menu
7639
7640 @node M2 Operators
7641 @subsubsection Operators
7642 @cindex Modula-2 operators
7643
7644 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7645 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7646 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
7647 following definitions hold:
7648
7649 @itemize @bullet
7650
7651 @item
7652 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
7653 their subranges.
7654
7655 @item
7656 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
7657
7658 @item
7659 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
7660
7661 @item
7662 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
7663 @var{type}}.
7664
7665 @item
7666 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
7667
7668 @item
7669 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
7670
7671 @item
7672 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
7673 @end itemize
7674
7675 @noindent
7676 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
7677 increasing precedence:
7678
7679 @table @code
7680 @item ,
7681 Function argument or array index separator.
7682
7683 @item :=
7684 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
7685 @var{value}.
7686
7687 @item <@r{, }>
7688 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
7689 types.
7690
7691 @item <=@r{, }>=
7692 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
7693 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
7694 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
7695
7696 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
7697 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
7698 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
7699 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
7700 comment character.
7701
7702 @item IN
7703 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
7704 Same precedence as @code{<}.
7705
7706 @item OR
7707 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
7708
7709 @item AND@r{, }&
7710 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
7711
7712 @item @@
7713 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7714
7715 @item +@r{, }-
7716 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
7717 and difference on set types.
7718
7719 @item *
7720 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
7721 on set types.
7722
7723 @item /
7724 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
7725 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
7726
7727 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
7728 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
7729 precedence as @code{*}.
7730
7731 @item -
7732 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
7733
7734 @item ^
7735 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
7736
7737 @item NOT
7738 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
7739 @code{^}.
7740
7741 @item .
7742 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
7743 precedence as @code{^}.
7744
7745 @item []
7746 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
7747
7748 @item ()
7749 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
7750 as @code{^}.
7751
7752 @item ::@r{, }.
7753 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
7754 @end table
7755
7756 @quotation
7757 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
7758 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
7759 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
7760 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
7761 @end quotation
7762
7763
7764 @node Built-In Func/Proc
7765 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
7766 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
7767
7768 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
7769 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
7770
7771 @table @var
7772
7773 @item a
7774 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
7775
7776 @item c
7777 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
7778
7779 @item i
7780 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
7781
7782 @item m
7783 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
7784 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
7785 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
7786
7787 @item n
7788 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
7789
7790 @item r
7791 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
7792
7793 @item t
7794 represents a type.
7795
7796 @item v
7797 represents a variable.
7798
7799 @item x
7800 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
7801 explanation of the function for details.
7802 @end table
7803
7804 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
7805
7806 @table @code
7807 @item ABS(@var{n})
7808 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
7809
7810 @item CAP(@var{c})
7811 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
7812 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
7813
7814 @item CHR(@var{i})
7815 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7816
7817 @item DEC(@var{v})
7818 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
7819
7820 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
7821 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7822 new value.
7823
7824 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7825 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
7826 set.
7827
7828 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
7829 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
7830
7831 @item HIGH(@var{a})
7832 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
7833
7834 @item INC(@var{v})
7835 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
7836
7837 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
7838 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7839 new value.
7840
7841 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7842 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
7843 there. Returns the new set.
7844
7845 @item MAX(@var{t})
7846 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
7847
7848 @item MIN(@var{t})
7849 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
7850
7851 @item ODD(@var{i})
7852 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
7853
7854 @item ORD(@var{x})
7855 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
7856 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
7857 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
7858 integral, character and enumerated types.
7859
7860 @item SIZE(@var{x})
7861 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
7862
7863 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
7864 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
7865
7866 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
7867 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7868 @end table
7869
7870 @quotation
7871 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
7872 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
7873 an error.
7874 @end quotation
7875
7876 @cindex Modula-2 constants
7877 @node M2 Constants
7878 @subsubsection Constants
7879
7880 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
7881 ways:
7882
7883 @itemize @bullet
7884
7885 @item
7886 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
7887 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
7888 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
7889 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
7890
7891 @item
7892 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
7893 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
7894 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
7895 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
7896 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
7897 digits.
7898
7899 @item
7900 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
7901 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
7902 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
7903 followed by a @samp{C}.
7904
7905 @item
7906 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
7907 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
7908 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
7909 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
7910 sequences.
7911
7912 @item
7913 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
7914
7915 @item
7916 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
7917 @code{FALSE}.
7918
7919 @item
7920 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
7921
7922 @item
7923 Set constants are not yet supported.
7924 @end itemize
7925
7926 @node M2 Defaults
7927 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
7928 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
7929
7930 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7931 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
7932 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
7933 selected the working language.
7934
7935 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7936 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
7937 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
7938 the language automatically}, for further details.
7939
7940 @node Deviations
7941 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
7942 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
7943
7944 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
7945 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
7946
7947 @itemize @bullet
7948 @item
7949 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
7950 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
7951 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
7952 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
7953 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
7954 returned a pointer.)
7955
7956 @item
7957 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
7958 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
7959 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
7960 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
7961
7962 @item
7963 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
7964 argument.
7965
7966 @item
7967 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
7968 @end itemize
7969
7970 @node M2 Checks
7971 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
7972 @cindex Modula-2 checks
7973
7974 @quotation
7975 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
7976 range checking.
7977 @end quotation
7978 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
7979
7980 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
7981
7982 @itemize @bullet
7983 @item
7984 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
7985 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
7986
7987 @item
7988 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
7989 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
7990 @end itemize
7991
7992 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
7993 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
7994
7995 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7996 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
7997
7998 @node M2 Scope
7999 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8000 @cindex scope
8001 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
8002 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8003 @ifinfo
8004 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
8005 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8006 @end ifinfo
8007 @iftex
8008 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
8009 @end iftex
8010
8011 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8012 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8013 similar syntax:
8014
8015 @example
8016
8017 @var{module} . @var{id}
8018 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
8019 @end example
8020
8021 @noindent
8022 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8023 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8024 identifier within your program, except another module.
8025
8026 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8027 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8028 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8029 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8030
8031 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8032 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8033 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8034 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8035 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8036 @var{module}.
8037
8038 @node GDB/M2
8039 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8040
8041 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8042 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
8043 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
8044 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
8045 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
8046 analogue in Modula-2.
8047
8048 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
8049 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
8050 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
8051 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
8052 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
8053 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
8054
8055 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8056 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8057 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
8058
8059 @node Chill
8060 @subsection Chill
8061
8062 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
8063 from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
8064 supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
8065 likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8066 table.
8067
8068 @c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
8069 @c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
8070 This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
8071 of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
8072
8073 @menu
8074 * How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
8075 * Locations:: Locations and their accesses
8076 * Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
8077 * Chill type and range checks::
8078 * Chill defaults::
8079 @end menu
8080
8081 @node How modes are displayed
8082 @subsubsection How modes are displayed
8083
8084 The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
8085 with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
8086 slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
8087 provided modes are:
8088
8089 @c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
8090 @c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
8091 @table @code
8092 @item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
8093 @itemize @bullet
8094 @item
8095 @emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
8096 UINT, LONG, ULONG},
8097 @item
8098 @emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
8099 @item
8100 @emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
8101 @item
8102 @emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
8103 @smallexample
8104 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8105 type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8106 @end smallexample
8107 If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
8108 @item
8109 @emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
8110 @smallexample
8111 @code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
8112 @end smallexample
8113 where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
8114 expression (e.g. set element names).
8115 @end itemize
8116
8117 @item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
8118 A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
8119 the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
8120 @smallexample
8121 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8122 type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
8123 @end smallexample
8124
8125 @item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
8126 @itemize @bullet
8127 @item
8128 @emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
8129 followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
8130 @item
8131 @emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
8132 @end itemize
8133
8134 @item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
8135 The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
8136 <return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
8137 list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
8138 the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
8139 all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
8140
8141 @ignore
8142 @item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
8143 The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
8144 type, and is therefore not really of interest.
8145 @end ignore
8146
8147 @item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
8148 @itemize @bullet
8149 @item
8150 @emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
8151 @smallexample
8152 @code{EVENT (<event length>)}
8153 @end smallexample
8154 where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
8155 @item
8156 @emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
8157 @smallexample
8158 @code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
8159 @end smallexample
8160 where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
8161 @end itemize
8162
8163 @item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
8164 @itemize @bullet
8165 @item
8166 @emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
8167 @item
8168 @emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
8169 @end itemize
8170
8171 @item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
8172 Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
8173
8174 @item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
8175 @itemize @bullet
8176 @item
8177 @emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
8178 @smallexample
8179 @code{CHARS(<string length>)}
8180 @end smallexample
8181 followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
8182 mode
8183 @item
8184 @emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
8185 @smallexample
8186 @code{BOOLS(<string
8187 length>)}
8188 @end smallexample
8189 @end itemize
8190
8191 @item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
8192 The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
8193 followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
8194 @smallexample
8195 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8196 type = ARRAY (1:42)
8197 ARRAY (1:20)
8198 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8199 @end smallexample
8200
8201 @item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
8202 The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
8203 list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
8204 of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
8205 OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
8206 of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
8207 checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
8208 always displays all variant fields.
8209 @smallexample
8210 (@value{GDBP}) ptype str
8211 type = STRUCT (
8212 as x,
8213 bs x,
8214 CASE bs OF
8215 (karli):
8216 cs a
8217 (ott):
8218 ds x
8219 ESAC
8220 )
8221 @end smallexample
8222 @end table
8223
8224 @node Locations
8225 @subsubsection Locations and their accesses
8226
8227 A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
8228
8229 A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
8230 the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
8231 Chill programs. How values are specified
8232 is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
8233
8234 The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
8235 display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
8236
8237 @smallexample
8238 set result := EXPR
8239 @end smallexample
8240
8241 @noindent
8242 This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
8243 is not available in @value{GDBN}).
8244
8245 Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
8246 value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
8247 mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
8248 represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
8249 value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
8250 operator @samp{->}.
8251
8252 Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
8253 @smallexample
8254 @code{@{ PROC
8255 (<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
8256 location>}
8257 @end smallexample
8258 @code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
8259 specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
8260 the entry point.
8261
8262 @ignore
8263 Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
8264 fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
8265 the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
8266 implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
8267 na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
8268 <instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
8269 @code{__proc_copy}.
8270
8271 Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
8272 the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
8273 like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
8274 mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
8275
8276 Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
8277 ...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
8278 definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
8279 of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
8280 structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
8281 braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
8282 on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
8283 memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
8284 all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
8285 @code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
8286 stuff ???)
8287 @smallexample
8288 (@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
8289 [.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
8290 @end smallexample
8291 @end ignore
8292
8293 Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
8294 (e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
8295 certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
8296 and their Operations}.
8297
8298 A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
8299 location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
8300 name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
8301 have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
8302 checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
8303 therefore the result can be quite confusing.
8304
8305 @smallexample
8306 (@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
8307 @end smallexample
8308
8309 @node Values and their Operations
8310 @subsubsection Values and their Operations
8311
8312 Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
8313 more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
8314 data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
8315 such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
8316 constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
8317 when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
8318 (e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
8319 the values behind these locations.
8320
8321 This section describes how values have to be specified and which
8322 operations are legal to be used with such values.
8323
8324 @table @code
8325 @item Literal Values
8326 Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
8327 For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
8328 chapter 1.5.
8329 @c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
8330 @c be converted to a @ref.
8331
8332 @ignore
8333 @itemize @bullet
8334 @item
8335 @emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
8336 programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
8337 @item
8338 @emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
8339 @item
8340 @emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
8341 @code{'M'})
8342 @item
8343 @emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
8344 mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
8345 comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
8346 @item
8347 @emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
8348 emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
8349 procedure value or the empty instance value.
8350
8351 @item
8352 @emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
8353 enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
8354 to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
8355 @item
8356 @emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
8357 programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
8358 @item
8359 @emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
8360 (gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
8361 @end itemize
8362 @end ignore
8363
8364 @item Tuple Values
8365 A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
8366 name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
8367 unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
8368 @code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
8369
8370 @itemize @bullet
8371 @item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
8372 @item @emph{Array Tuple}
8373 @item @emph{Structure Tuple}
8374 Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
8375 same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
8376 @end itemize
8377
8378 @item String Element Value
8379 A string element value is specified by
8380 @smallexample
8381 @code{<string value>(<index>)}
8382 @end smallexample
8383 where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
8384 value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
8385 the string.
8386
8387 @item String Slice Value
8388 A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
8389 spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
8390 expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
8391 @code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
8392 The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
8393 string.
8394
8395 @item Array Element Values
8396 An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
8397 delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
8398
8399 @item Array Slice Values
8400 An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
8401 @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
8402 @code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
8403 arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
8404 which is part of the specified array.
8405
8406 @item Structure Field Values
8407 A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
8408 name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
8409 in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
8410 corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
8411
8412 @item Procedure Call Value
8413 The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
8414 procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
8415 expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
8416 effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
8417
8418 Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
8419
8420 Values of time mode locations appear as
8421 @smallexample
8422 @code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
8423 @end smallexample
8424
8425
8426 @ignore
8427 This is not implemented yet:
8428 @item Built-in Value
8429 @noindent
8430 The following built in functions are provided:
8431
8432 @table @code
8433 @item @code{ADDR()}
8434 @item @code{NUM()}
8435 @item @code{PRED()}
8436 @item @code{SUCC()}
8437 @item @code{ABS()}
8438 @item @code{CARD()}
8439 @item @code{MAX()}
8440 @item @code{MIN()}
8441 @item @code{SIZE()}
8442 @item @code{UPPER()}
8443 @item @code{LOWER()}
8444 @item @code{LENGTH()}
8445 @item @code{SIN()}
8446 @item @code{COS()}
8447 @item @code{TAN()}
8448 @item @code{ARCSIN()}
8449 @item @code{ARCCOS()}
8450 @item @code{ARCTAN()}
8451 @item @code{EXP()}
8452 @item @code{LN()}
8453 @item @code{LOG()}
8454 @item @code{SQRT()}
8455 @end table
8456
8457 For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
8458 chapter 1.6.
8459 @end ignore
8460
8461 @item Zero-adic Operator Value
8462 The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
8463 current active process.
8464
8465 @item Expression Values
8466 The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
8467 the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
8468 incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
8469 corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
8470 causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
8471 which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
8472 operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
8473
8474 @table @code
8475 @item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
8476 @itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
8477 @itemx @code{NOT}
8478 Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
8479
8480 @item @code{=, /=}
8481 Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
8482
8483 @item @code{>, >=}
8484 @itemx @code{<, <=}
8485 Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
8486
8487 @item @code{+, -}
8488 @itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
8489 Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
8490
8491 @item @code{-}
8492 Change sign operator.
8493
8494 @item @code{//}
8495 String concatenation operator.
8496
8497 @item @code{()}
8498 String repetition operator.
8499
8500 @item @code{->}
8501 Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
8502 address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
8503 location (@code{loc->}).
8504
8505 @item @code{OR, XOR}
8506 @itemx @code{AND}
8507 @itemx @code{NOT}
8508 Powerset and bitstring operators.
8509
8510 @item @code{>, >=}
8511 @itemx @code{<, <=}
8512 Powerset inclusion operators.
8513
8514 @item @code{IN}
8515 Membership operator.
8516 @end table
8517 @end table
8518
8519 @node Chill type and range checks
8520 @subsubsection Chill type and range checks
8521
8522 @value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
8523 of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
8524 complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
8525 equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
8526 structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
8527
8528 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8529 index bounds and all built in procedures.
8530
8531 Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
8532 check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
8533 operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
8534 functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
8535 language specification.
8536
8537 All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
8538 off}.
8539
8540 @ignore
8541 @c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
8542 see last paragraph ?
8543 @end ignore
8544
8545 @node Chill defaults
8546 @subsubsection Chill defaults
8547
8548 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8549 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
8550 Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8551 selected the working language.
8552
8553 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8554 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
8555 working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
8556 the language automatically}, for further details.
8557
8558 @node Symbols
8559 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8560
8561 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
8562 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8563 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8564 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8565 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8566 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8567 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8568
8569 @cindex symbol names
8570 @cindex names of symbols
8571 @cindex quoting names
8572 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8573 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8574 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8575 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8576 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8577 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8578 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8579 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8580
8581 @example
8582 p 'foo.c'::x
8583 @end example
8584
8585 @noindent
8586 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8587
8588 @table @code
8589 @kindex info address
8590 @cindex address of a symbol
8591 @item info address @var{symbol}
8592 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8593 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8594 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8595 is always stored.
8596
8597 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8598 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8599 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8600
8601 @kindex info symbol
8602 @cindex symbol from address
8603 @item info symbol @var{addr}
8604 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8605 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8606 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8607
8608 @example
8609 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8610 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8611 @end example
8612
8613 @noindent
8614 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8615 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8616
8617 @kindex whatis
8618 @item whatis @var{expr}
8619 Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
8620 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8621 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8622 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8623
8624 @item whatis
8625 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8626
8627 @kindex ptype
8628 @item ptype @var{typename}
8629 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
8630 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8631 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8632 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
8633
8634 @item ptype @var{expr}
8635 @itemx ptype
8636 Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
8637 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8638 of just the name of the type.
8639
8640 For example, for this variable declaration:
8641
8642 @example
8643 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8644 @end example
8645
8646 @noindent
8647 the two commands give this output:
8648
8649 @example
8650 @group
8651 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8652 type = struct complex
8653 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8654 type = struct complex @{
8655 double real;
8656 double imag;
8657 @}
8658 @end group
8659 @end example
8660
8661 @noindent
8662 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8663 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8664
8665 @kindex info types
8666 @item info types @var{regexp}
8667 @itemx info types
8668 Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
8669 (or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8670 complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8671 @samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
8672 names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
8673 information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8674
8675 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8676 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8677 lists all source files where a type is defined.
8678
8679 @kindex info scope
8680 @cindex local variables
8681 @item info scope @var{addr}
8682 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8683 accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8684 preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8685 scope defined by that location. For example:
8686
8687 @smallexample
8688 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8689 Scope for command_line_handler:
8690 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8691 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8692 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8693 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8694 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8695 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8696 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8697 @end smallexample
8698
8699 @noindent
8700 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8701 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8702 collect}.
8703
8704 @kindex info source
8705 @item info source
8706 Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
8707 the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
8708 it was written in.
8709
8710 @kindex info sources
8711 @item info sources
8712 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8713 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8714 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8715
8716 @kindex info functions
8717 @item info functions
8718 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8719
8720 @item info functions @var{regexp}
8721 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8722 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8723 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8724 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
8725 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8726 that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8727 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
8728
8729 @kindex info variables
8730 @item info variables
8731 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
8732 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
8733
8734 @item info variables @var{regexp}
8735 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8736 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8737 @var{regexp}.
8738
8739 @ignore
8740 This was never implemented.
8741 @kindex info methods
8742 @item info methods
8743 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8744 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
8745 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8746 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8747 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
8748 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8749 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8750 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8751 @end ignore
8752
8753 @cindex reloading symbols
8754 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
8755 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8756 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8757 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8758 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
8759
8760 @table @code
8761 @kindex set symbol-reloading
8762 @item set symbol-reloading on
8763 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8764 object file with a particular name is seen again.
8765
8766 @item set symbol-reloading off
8767 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8768 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8769 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8770 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8771 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8772 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8773 name.
8774
8775 @kindex show symbol-reloading
8776 @item show symbol-reloading
8777 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8778 @end table
8779
8780 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8781 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
8782 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8783 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8784 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8785 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8786 another source file. The default is on.
8787
8788 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8789 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8790
8791 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
8792 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8793 is printed as follows:
8794 @smallexample
8795 @{<no data fields>@}
8796 @end smallexample
8797
8798 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8799 @item show opaque-type-resolution
8800 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
8801
8802 @kindex maint print symbols
8803 @cindex symbol dump
8804 @kindex maint print psymbols
8805 @cindex partial symbol dump
8806 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8807 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8808 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8809 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8810 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
8811 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
8812 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
8813 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
8814 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
8815 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
8816 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
8817 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
8818 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
8819 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
8820 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
8821 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
8822 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
8823 @end table
8824
8825 @node Altering
8826 @chapter Altering Execution
8827
8828 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
8829 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
8830 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
8831 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
8832 program.
8833
8834 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
8835 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
8836 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
8837
8838 @menu
8839 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
8840 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
8841 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
8842 * Returning:: Returning from a function
8843 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
8844 * Patching:: Patching your program
8845 @end menu
8846
8847 @node Assignment
8848 @section Assignment to variables
8849
8850 @cindex assignment
8851 @cindex setting variables
8852 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
8853 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
8854
8855 @example
8856 print x=4
8857 @end example
8858
8859 @noindent
8860 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
8861 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
8862 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
8863 information on operators in supported languages.
8864
8865 @kindex set variable
8866 @cindex variables, setting
8867 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
8868 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
8869 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
8870 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
8871 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
8872
8873 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
8874 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
8875 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
8876 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
8877 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
8878 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
8879 command @code{set width}:
8880
8881 @example
8882 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
8883 type = double
8884 (@value{GDBP}) p width
8885 $4 = 13
8886 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
8887 Invalid syntax in expression.
8888 @end example
8889
8890 @noindent
8891 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
8892 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
8893
8894 @example
8895 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
8896 @end example
8897
8898 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
8899 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
8900 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
8901 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
8902 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
8903 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
8904
8905 @example
8906 @group
8907 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
8908 type = double
8909 (@value{GDBP}) p g
8910 $1 = 1
8911 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
8912 (@value{GDBP}) p g
8913 $2 = 1
8914 (@value{GDBP}) r
8915 The program being debugged has been started already.
8916 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
8917 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
8918 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
8919 Invalid bfd target.
8920 (@value{GDBP}) show g
8921 The current BFD target is "=4".
8922 @end group
8923 @end example
8924
8925 @noindent
8926 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
8927 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
8928 @code{g}, use
8929
8930 @example
8931 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
8932 @end example
8933
8934 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
8935 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
8936 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
8937 same length or shorter.
8938 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
8939 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
8940
8941 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
8942 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
8943 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
8944 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
8945 and representation in memory), and
8946
8947 @example
8948 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
8949 @end example
8950
8951 @noindent
8952 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
8953
8954 @node Jumping
8955 @section Continuing at a different address
8956
8957 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
8958 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
8959 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
8960
8961 @table @code
8962 @kindex jump
8963 @item jump @var{linespec}
8964 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
8965 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
8966 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
8967 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
8968 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
8969 breakpoints}.
8970
8971 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
8972 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
8973 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
8974 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
8975 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
8976 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
8977 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
8978 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
8979 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
8980
8981 @item jump *@var{address}
8982 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
8983 @end table
8984
8985 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
8986 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
8987 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
8988 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
8989 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
8990 example,
8991
8992 @example
8993 set $pc = 0x485
8994 @end example
8995
8996 @noindent
8997 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
8998 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
8999 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
9000
9001 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9002 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9003 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9004 detail.
9005
9006 @c @group
9007 @node Signaling
9008 @section Giving your program a signal
9009
9010 @table @code
9011 @kindex signal
9012 @item signal @var{signal}
9013 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9014 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9015 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9016 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9017
9018 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9019 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9020 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9021 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9022 signal.
9023
9024 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9025 after executing the command.
9026 @end table
9027 @c @end group
9028
9029 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9030 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9031 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9032 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9033 passes the signal directly to your program.
9034
9035
9036 @node Returning
9037 @section Returning from a function
9038
9039 @table @code
9040 @cindex returning from a function
9041 @kindex return
9042 @item return
9043 @itemx return @var{expression}
9044 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9045 command. If you give an
9046 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9047 value.
9048 @end table
9049
9050 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9051 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9052 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9053 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9054
9055 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9056 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9057 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9058 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9059 of functions.
9060
9061 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9062 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9063 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9064 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9065 selected stack frame returns naturally.
9066
9067 @node Calling
9068 @section Calling program functions
9069
9070 @cindex calling functions
9071 @kindex call
9072 @table @code
9073 @item call @var{expr}
9074 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9075 returned values.
9076 @end table
9077
9078 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9079 execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
9080 with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9081 is printed and saved in the value history.
9082
9083 @c OBSOLETE For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
9084 @c OBSOLETE specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
9085 @c OBSOLETE calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
9086 @c OBSOLETE method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
9087 @c OBSOLETE that have separate instruction and data spaces.
9088
9089 @node Patching
9090 @section Patching programs
9091
9092 @cindex patching binaries
9093 @cindex writing into executables
9094 @cindex writing into corefiles
9095
9096 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9097 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9098 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9099 patching your program's binary.
9100
9101 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9102 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9103 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9104 repairs.
9105
9106 @table @code
9107 @kindex set write
9108 @item set write on
9109 @itemx set write off
9110 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9111 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
9112 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9113
9114 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
9115 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9116 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
9117
9118 @item show write
9119 @kindex show write
9120 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9121 as well as reading.
9122 @end table
9123
9124 @node GDB Files
9125 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9126
9127 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9128 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9129 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9130 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
9131
9132 @menu
9133 * Files:: Commands to specify files
9134 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9135 @end menu
9136
9137 @node Files
9138 @section Commands to specify files
9139
9140 @cindex symbol table
9141 @cindex core dump file
9142
9143 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9144 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9145 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9146 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
9147
9148 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9149 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9150 a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9151 to specify new files are useful.
9152
9153 @table @code
9154 @cindex executable file
9155 @kindex file
9156 @item file @var{filename}
9157 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9158 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9159 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
9160 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9161 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9162 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9163 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
9164 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9165
9166 On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
9167 @file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9168 @var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9169 @file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9170 descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9171 (available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
9172 @code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
9173 for more information.
9174
9175 @item file
9176 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9177 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9178
9179 @kindex exec-file
9180 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9181 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9182 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9183 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9184 discard information on the executable file.
9185
9186 @kindex symbol-file
9187 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9188 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9189 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9190 table and program to run from the same file.
9191
9192 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9193 program's symbol table.
9194
9195 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
9196 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9197 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9198 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9199 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9200
9201 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9202 executing it once.
9203
9204 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9205 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9206 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9207 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
9208 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9209 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9210 optimized code.
9211
9212 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9213 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9214 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9215 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9216 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9217
9218 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9219 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9220 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9221 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9222 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9223 warnings and messages}.)
9224
9225 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9226 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9227 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9228 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9229 in stabs format.
9230
9231 @kindex readnow
9232 @cindex reading symbols immediately
9233 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
9234 @kindex mapped
9235 @cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9236 @cindex saving symbol table
9237 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9238 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9239 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9240 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9241 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
9242 entire symbol table available.
9243
9244 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9245 @code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9246 cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9247 file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9248 from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9249 than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9250 program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9251 starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9252
9253 You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9254 file has all the symbol information for your program.
9255
9256 The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9257 @samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9258 than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9259 it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9260 needed.
9261
9262 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9263 @value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9264 symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
9265
9266 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9267 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9268 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9269 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9270 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9271 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9272 @c files.
9273
9274 @kindex core
9275 @kindex core-file
9276 @item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9277 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9278 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9279 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9280 executable file itself for other parts.
9281
9282 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9283 to be used.
9284
9285 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
9286 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9287 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9288 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
9289 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
9290
9291 @kindex add-symbol-file
9292 @cindex dynamic linking
9293 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9294 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9295 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
9296 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9297 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9298 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9299 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9300 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
9301 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9302 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9303 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9304 @var{address} as an expression.
9305
9306 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9307 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
9308 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9309 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9310 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
9311
9312 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9313 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9314 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9315 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9316 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9317 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9318 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9319 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9320 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9321
9322 @itemize @bullet
9323 @item
9324 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9325 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9326 @item
9327 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9328 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9329 @item
9330 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9331 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9332 @end itemize
9333
9334 @noindent
9335 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9336 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9337 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9338 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9339 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9340 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9341 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9342 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9343 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9344 way.
9345
9346 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9347
9348 You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9349 the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9350 table information for @var{filename}.
9351
9352 @kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9353 @item add-shared-symbol-file
9354 The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
9355 operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9356 shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
9357 @code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
9358
9359 @kindex section
9360 @item section
9361 The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9362 the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9363 section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9364 specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
9365 separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9366 the sections and their addresses.
9367
9368 @kindex info files
9369 @kindex info target
9370 @item info files
9371 @itemx info target
9372 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9373 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9374 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9375 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9376 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9377 current ones.
9378
9379 @kindex maint info sections
9380 @item maint info sections
9381 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9382 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9383 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9384 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9385 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9386 may be arbitrarily combined):
9387
9388 @table @code
9389 @item ALLOBJ
9390 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9391 @item @var{sections}
9392 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
9393 @item @var{section-flags}
9394 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9395 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9396 @table @code
9397 @item ALLOC
9398 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9399 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9400 @item LOAD
9401 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9402 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9403 @item RELOC
9404 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9405 @item READONLY
9406 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9407 @item CODE
9408 Section contains executable code only.
9409 @item DATA
9410 Section contains data only (no executable code).
9411 @item ROM
9412 Section will reside in ROM.
9413 @item CONSTRUCTOR
9414 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9415 @item HAS_CONTENTS
9416 Section is not empty.
9417 @item NEVER_LOAD
9418 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9419 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9420 A notification to the linker that the section contains
9421 COFF shared library information.
9422 @item IS_COMMON
9423 Section contains common symbols.
9424 @end table
9425 @end table
9426 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9427 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
9428 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
9429 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
9430 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9431 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9432 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9433 enhancement to debugging performance.
9434
9435 The default is off.
9436
9437 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
9438 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
9439 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9440 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
9441 @end table
9442
9443 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9444 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9445 name and remembers it that way.
9446
9447 @cindex shared libraries
9448 @value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9449 libraries.
9450
9451 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9452 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9453 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9454 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9455 debugging a core file).
9456
9457 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9458 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9459
9460 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9461 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9462 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9463
9464 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9465 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9466 particularly large or there are many of them.
9467
9468 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9469 commands:
9470
9471 @table @code
9472 @kindex set auto-solib-add
9473 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9474 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9475 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9476 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9477 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9478 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9479 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9480
9481 @kindex show auto-solib-add
9482 @item show auto-solib-add
9483 Display the current autoloading mode.
9484 @end table
9485
9486 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9487 command:
9488
9489 @table @code
9490 @kindex info sharedlibrary
9491 @kindex info share
9492 @item info share
9493 @itemx info sharedlibrary
9494 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9495
9496 @kindex sharedlibrary
9497 @kindex share
9498 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9499 @itemx share @var{regex}
9500 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9501 Unix regular expression.
9502 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9503 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9504 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9505 loaded.
9506 @end table
9507
9508 On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9509 autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9510 reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9511 by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9512 up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9513 wish.
9514
9515 Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
9516 loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9517 @var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
9518 automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9519
9520 To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9521
9522 @table @code
9523 @kindex set auto-solib-limit
9524 @item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9525 Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9526 If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9527 symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9528 size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
9529 Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9530 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
9531 Mb).
9532
9533 @kindex show auto-solib-limit
9534 @item show auto-solib-limit
9535 Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9536 @end table
9537
9538 @node Symbol Errors
9539 @section Errors reading symbol files
9540
9541 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9542 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9543 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9544 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9545 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9546 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9547 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9548 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9549 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9550 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9551 messages}).
9552
9553 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9554
9555 @table @code
9556 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9557
9558 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9559 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9560 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9561 in its outer scope blocks.
9562
9563 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9564 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9565 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9566 function.
9567
9568 @item block at @var{address} out of order
9569
9570 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9571 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9572 do so.
9573
9574 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9575 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9576 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9577 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9578 messages}.)
9579
9580 @item bad block start address patched
9581
9582 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9583 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9584 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9585
9586 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9587 starting on the previous source line.
9588
9589 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9590
9591 @cindex foo
9592 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9593 larger than the size of the string table.
9594
9595 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9596 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9597 with this name.
9598
9599 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9600
9601 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9602 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
9603 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
9604
9605 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9606 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
9607 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
9608 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9609 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9610 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
9611
9612 @item stub type has NULL name
9613
9614 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
9615
9616 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
9617 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
9618 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9619 it.
9620
9621 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9622
9623 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
9624
9625 @end table
9626
9627 @node Targets
9628 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
9629
9630 @cindex debugging target
9631 @kindex target
9632
9633 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
9634
9635 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9636 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9637 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
9638 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9639 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
9640 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9641 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9642 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
9643
9644 @menu
9645 * Active Targets:: Active targets
9646 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
9647 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9648 * Remote:: Remote debugging
9649 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
9650
9651 @end menu
9652
9653 @node Active Targets
9654 @section Active targets
9655
9656 @cindex stacking targets
9657 @cindex active targets
9658 @cindex multiple targets
9659
9660 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
9661 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9662 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9663 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9664 a core file.
9665
9666 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9667 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9668 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9669 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9670 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9671 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9672 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9673 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9674 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
9675
9676 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
9677 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9678 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9679 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9680 process target is active.
9681
9682 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9683 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
9684 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
9685 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9686 process}).
9687
9688 @node Target Commands
9689 @section Commands for managing targets
9690
9691 @table @code
9692 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
9693 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9694 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9695 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9696 protocol of the target machine.
9697
9698 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9699 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9700 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
9701
9702 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9703 after executing the command.
9704
9705 @kindex help target
9706 @item help target
9707 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9708 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9709 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9710
9711 @item help target @var{name}
9712 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9713 select it.
9714
9715 @kindex set gnutarget
9716 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
9717 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
9718 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
9719 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9720 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
9721 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9722
9723 @quotation
9724 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9725 you must know the actual BFD name.
9726 @end quotation
9727
9728 @noindent
9729 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
9730
9731 @kindex show gnutarget
9732 @item show gnutarget
9733 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9734 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9735 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9736 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9737 @end table
9738
9739 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9740 configuration):
9741
9742 @table @code
9743 @kindex target exec
9744 @item target exec @var{program}
9745 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9746 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9747
9748 @kindex target core
9749 @item target core @var{filename}
9750 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9751 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
9752
9753 @kindex target remote
9754 @item target remote @var{dev}
9755 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9756 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9757 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
9758 supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
9759 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9760 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9761
9762 @kindex target sim
9763 @item target sim
9764 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
9765 In general,
9766 @example
9767 target sim
9768 load
9769 run
9770 @end example
9771 @noindent
9772 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
9773 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
9774 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9775 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9776 Processors}.
9777
9778 @end table
9779
9780 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
9781
9782 @table @code
9783
9784 @kindex target nrom
9785 @item target nrom @var{dev}
9786 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9787
9788 @end table
9789
9790 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
9791 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
9792
9793 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9794 once you've successfully established a connection.
9795
9796 @table @code
9797
9798 @kindex load @var{filename}
9799 @item load @var{filename}
9800 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9801 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9802 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9803 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9804 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9805 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9806
9807 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9808 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9809 target is @dots{}}''
9810
9811 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9812 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9813 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9814 specifies a fixed address.
9815 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9816
9817 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9818 @end table
9819
9820 @node Byte Order
9821 @section Choosing target byte order
9822
9823 @cindex choosing target byte order
9824 @cindex target byte order
9825
9826 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
9827 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
9828 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
9829 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
9830 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
9831 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
9832
9833 @table @code
9834 @kindex set endian big
9835 @item set endian big
9836 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
9837
9838 @kindex set endian little
9839 @item set endian little
9840 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
9841
9842 @kindex set endian auto
9843 @item set endian auto
9844 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
9845 executable.
9846
9847 @item show endian
9848 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
9849
9850 @end table
9851
9852 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
9853 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
9854 target system.
9855
9856 @node Remote
9857 @section Remote debugging
9858 @cindex remote debugging
9859
9860 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
9861 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
9862 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
9863 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
9864 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
9865
9866 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
9867 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
9868 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
9869 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
9870 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
9871 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
9872
9873 Other remote targets may be available in your
9874 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
9875
9876 @node KOD
9877 @section Kernel Object Display
9878
9879 @cindex kernel object display
9880 @cindex kernel object
9881 @cindex KOD
9882
9883 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9884 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9885 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9886 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9887 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9888
9889 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9890 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9891
9892 @example
9893 (@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
9894 @end example
9895
9896 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9897 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9898 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9899 after the operating system:
9900
9901 @example
9902 (@value{GDBP}) info cisco
9903 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9904 Object Description
9905 any Any and all objects
9906 @end example
9907
9908 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9909 by the kernel.
9910
9911 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
9912 is supported other than to try it.
9913
9914
9915 @node Remote Debugging
9916 @chapter Debugging remote programs
9917
9918 @menu
9919 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
9920 * NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
9921 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
9922 @end menu
9923
9924 @node Server
9925 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9926
9927 @kindex gdbserver
9928 @cindex remote connection without stubs
9929 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
9930 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9931 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
9932
9933 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
9934 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
9935 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
9936 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
9937 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
9938 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
9939 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
9940 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
9941 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
9942 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
9943 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
9944 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
9945 choice for debugging.
9946
9947 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
9948 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
9949 protocol.
9950
9951 @table @emph
9952 @item On the target machine,
9953 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9954 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
9955 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
9956 system does all the symbol handling.
9957
9958 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
9959 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
9960 syntax is:
9961
9962 @smallexample
9963 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9964 @end smallexample
9965
9966 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
9967 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
9968 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
9969 @file{/dev/com1}:
9970
9971 @smallexample
9972 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
9973 @end smallexample
9974
9975 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
9976 with it.
9977
9978 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
9979
9980 @smallexample
9981 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
9982 @end smallexample
9983
9984 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
9985 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
9986 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
9987 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
9988 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
9989 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
9990 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
9991 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
9992 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
9993 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
9994 @code{target remote} command.
9995
9996 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9997 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9998 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9999 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10000 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10001 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10002 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10003 is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10004 @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10005 @code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10006
10007 @smallexample
10008 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10009 @end smallexample
10010
10011 @noindent
10012 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10013
10014 @smallexample
10015 (@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10016 @end smallexample
10017
10018 @noindent
10019 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10020 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10021 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10022 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10023 @samp{Connection refused}.
10024 @end table
10025
10026 @node NetWare
10027 @section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10028
10029 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
10030 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10031 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10032 @code{target remote}.
10033
10034 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10035 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10036
10037 @table @emph
10038 @item On the target machine,
10039 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10040 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10041 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10042 host system does all the symbol handling.
10043
10044 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10045 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10046 program. The syntax is:
10047
10048 @smallexample
10049 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10050 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10051 @end smallexample
10052
10053 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10054 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10055 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10056
10057 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10058 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10059 using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10060
10061 @smallexample
10062 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10063 @end smallexample
10064
10065 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10066 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10067 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10068 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10069 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10070 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10071 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10072 argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10073 @file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10074
10075 @smallexample
10076 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10077 @end smallexample
10078
10079 @noindent
10080 communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10081 @end table
10082
10083 @node remote stub
10084 @section Implementing a remote stub
10085
10086 @cindex debugging stub, example
10087 @cindex remote stub, example
10088 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
10089 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10090 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10091 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10092 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10093 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10094 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10095 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10096
10097 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10098 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10099 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10100 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10101 program, you need:
10102
10103 @enumerate
10104 @item
10105 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10106 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10107 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
10108
10109 @item
10110 A C subroutine library to support your program's
10111 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
10112
10113 @item
10114 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10115 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10116 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10117 documentation.
10118 @end enumerate
10119
10120 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10121 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10122 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
10123
10124 @table @emph
10125 @item On the host,
10126 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10127 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10128 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10129
10130 @item On the target,
10131 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10132 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10133 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10134
10135 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10136 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10137 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10138 @end table
10139
10140 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10141 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10142 @sc{sparc} boards.
10143
10144 @cindex remote serial stub list
10145 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
10146
10147 @table @code
10148
10149 @item i386-stub.c
10150 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
10151 @cindex Intel
10152 @cindex i386
10153 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10154
10155 @item m68k-stub.c
10156 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
10157 @cindex Motorola 680x0
10158 @cindex m680x0
10159 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10160
10161 @item sh-stub.c
10162 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
10163 @cindex Hitachi
10164 @cindex SH
10165 For Hitachi SH architectures.
10166
10167 @item sparc-stub.c
10168 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
10169 @cindex Sparc
10170 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10171
10172 @item sparcl-stub.c
10173 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
10174 @cindex Fujitsu
10175 @cindex SparcLite
10176 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10177
10178 @end table
10179
10180 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10181 recently added stubs.
10182
10183 @menu
10184 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10185 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10186 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
10187 @end menu
10188
10189 @node Stub Contents
10190 @subsection What the stub can do for you
10191
10192 @cindex remote serial stub
10193 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10194 subroutines:
10195
10196 @table @code
10197 @item set_debug_traps
10198 @kindex set_debug_traps
10199 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10200 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10201 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10202 beginning of your program.
10203
10204 @item handle_exception
10205 @kindex handle_exception
10206 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10207 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10208 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10209 run when a trap is triggered.
10210
10211 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10212 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10213 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10214 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
10215 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
10216 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10217 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10218 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10219 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
10220 machine.
10221
10222 @item breakpoint
10223 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10224 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10225 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10226 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10227 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10228 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10229 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10230 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10231 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10232 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
10233 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
10234
10235 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10236 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10237 start of your debugging session.
10238 @end table
10239
10240 @node Bootstrapping
10241 @subsection What you must do for the stub
10242
10243 @cindex remote stub, support routines
10244 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10245 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10246 debugging target machine.
10247
10248 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10249 serial port.
10250
10251 @table @code
10252 @item int getDebugChar()
10253 @kindex getDebugChar
10254 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10255 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10256 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10257
10258 @item void putDebugChar(int)
10259 @kindex putDebugChar
10260 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
10261 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
10262 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10263 @end table
10264
10265 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
10266 @cindex interrupting remote targets
10267 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10268 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10269 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10270 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10271 remote system to stop.
10272
10273 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10274 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10275 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10276 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10277
10278 Other routines you need to supply are:
10279
10280 @table @code
10281 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10282 @kindex exceptionHandler
10283 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10284 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10285 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10286 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10287 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10288 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10289 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10290 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10291 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10292 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10293 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10294 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10295 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10296
10297 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10298 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10299 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10300 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10301 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10302
10303 @item void flush_i_cache()
10304 @kindex flush_i_cache
10305 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
10306 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10307 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10308
10309 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10310 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10311 @end table
10312
10313 @noindent
10314 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10315
10316 @table @code
10317 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10318 @kindex memset
10319 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10320 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10321 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10322 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10323 @end table
10324
10325 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10326 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10327 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
10328 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
10329
10330
10331 @node Debug Session
10332 @subsection Putting it all together
10333
10334 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
10335 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10336 steps.
10337
10338 @enumerate
10339 @item
10340 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
10341 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10342 @display
10343 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10344 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10345 @end display
10346
10347 @item
10348 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10349
10350 @example
10351 set_debug_traps();
10352 breakpoint();
10353 @end example
10354
10355 @item
10356 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10357 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10358
10359 @example
10360 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
10361 @end example
10362
10363 @noindent
10364 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
10365 function in your program, that function is called when
10366 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10367 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10368 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10369
10370 @item
10371 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10372 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10373
10374 @item
10375 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10376 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10377
10378 @item
10379 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10380 @c document that. FIXME.
10381 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10382 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10383
10384 @item
10385 To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10386 as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10387 This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10388 of its pure text.
10389
10390 @item
10391 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
10392 Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
10393 Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10394 machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
10395 TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
10396 to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10397 device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10398
10399 @example
10400 target remote /dev/ttyb
10401 @end example
10402
10403 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10404 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
10405 @code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
10406 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10407
10408 @example
10409 target remote manyfarms:2828
10410 @end example
10411
10412 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10413 your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10414 the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10415 to port 1234 on your local machine:
10416
10417 @example
10418 target remote :1234
10419 @end example
10420 @noindent
10421
10422 Note that the colon is still required here.
10423 @end enumerate
10424
10425 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10426 step and continue the remote program.
10427
10428 To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10429 command.
10430
10431 @cindex interrupting remote programs
10432 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
10433 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10434 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10435 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10436 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10437 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10438
10439 @example
10440 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10441 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
10442 @end example
10443
10444 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10445 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10446 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10447 goes back to waiting.
10448
10449
10450 @node Configurations
10451 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
10452
10453 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10454 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10455 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
10456
10457 There are three major categories of configurations: native
10458 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10459 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10460 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10461 are quite different from each other.
10462
10463 @menu
10464 * Native::
10465 * Embedded OS::
10466 * Embedded Processors::
10467 * Architectures::
10468 @end menu
10469
10470 @node Native
10471 @section Native
10472
10473 This section describes details specific to particular native
10474 configurations.
10475
10476 @menu
10477 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
10478 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10479 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
10480 @end menu
10481
10482 @node HP-UX
10483 @subsection HP-UX
10484
10485 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10486 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10487 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10488
10489 @node SVR4 Process Information
10490 @subsection SVR4 process information
10491
10492 @kindex /proc
10493 @cindex process image
10494
10495 Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10496 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10497 subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10498 this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10499 several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10500 @code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10501 @code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10502 and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
10503
10504 @table @code
10505 @kindex info proc
10506 @item info proc
10507 Summarize available information about the process.
10508
10509 @kindex info proc mappings
10510 @item info proc mappings
10511 Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10512 on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10513 @ignore
10514 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
10515 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
10516 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
10517 @kindex info proc times
10518 @item info proc times
10519 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10520 its children.
10521
10522 @kindex info proc id
10523 @item info proc id
10524 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10525 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
10526
10527 @kindex info proc status
10528 @item info proc status
10529 General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10530 stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10531 received.
10532
10533 @item info proc all
10534 Show all the above information about the process.
10535 @end ignore
10536 @end table
10537
10538 @node DJGPP Native
10539 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
10540 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
10541 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
10542 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
10543
10544 @sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
10545 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
10546 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
10547 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
10548
10549 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
10550 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
10551 subsection describes those commands.
10552
10553 @table @code
10554 @kindex info dos
10555 @item info dos
10556 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
10557 information about the target system and important OS structures.
10558
10559 @kindex sysinfo
10560 @cindex MS-DOS system info
10561 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
10562 @item info dos sysinfo
10563 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
10564 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
10565 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
10566
10567 @cindex GDT
10568 @cindex LDT
10569 @cindex IDT
10570 @cindex segment descriptor tables
10571 @cindex descriptor tables display
10572 @item info dos gdt
10573 @itemx info dos ldt
10574 @itemx info dos idt
10575 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
10576 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
10577 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
10578 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
10579 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
10580 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
10581 rights.
10582
10583 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
10584 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
10585 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
10586 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
10587 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
10588
10589 @cindex garbled pointers
10590 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
10591 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
10592 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
10593 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
10594 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
10595 debugged program's data segment:
10596
10597 @smallexample
10598 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
10599 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
10600 @end smallexample
10601
10602 @noindent
10603 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
10604 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
10605
10606 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
10607 @item info dos pde
10608 @itemx info dos pte
10609 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
10610 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
10611 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
10612 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
10613 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
10614 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
10615 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
10616 that is currently in use.
10617
10618 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
10619 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
10620 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
10621 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
10622 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
10623 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
10624 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
10625
10626 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
10627 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
10628 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
10629 controller.
10630
10631 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
10632
10633 @cindex physical address from linear address
10634 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
10635 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
10636 address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
10637 appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
10638 accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
10639 example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
10640 the variable @code{i} is stored:
10641
10642 @smallexample
10643 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
10644 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
10645 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
10646 @end smallexample
10647
10648 @noindent
10649 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
10650 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
10651 attributes of that page.
10652
10653 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
10654 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
10655 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
10656 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
10657 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
10658 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
10659
10660 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
10661 transfer buffer:
10662
10663 @smallexample
10664 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
10665 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
10666 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
10667 @end smallexample
10668
10669 @noindent
10670 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
10671 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
10672 this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
10673 mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
10674
10675 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
10676 @end table
10677
10678 @node Embedded OS
10679 @section Embedded Operating Systems
10680
10681 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10682 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10683 architectures.
10684
10685 @menu
10686 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10687 @end menu
10688
10689 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10690 various real-time operating systems.
10691
10692 @node VxWorks
10693 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10694
10695 @cindex VxWorks
10696
10697 @table @code
10698
10699 @kindex target vxworks
10700 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10701 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10702 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
10703
10704 @end table
10705
10706 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
10707 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
10708
10709 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
10710 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
10711 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10712 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
10713 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
10714 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
10715 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
10716
10717 @table @code
10718 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
10719 @kindex vxworks-timeout
10720 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
10721 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10722 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
10723 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
10724 of a thin network line.
10725 @end table
10726
10727 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
10728 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
10729 procedures.
10730
10731 @kindex INCLUDE_RDB
10732 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
10733 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
10734 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
10735 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
10736 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
10737 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
10738 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
10739 manual.
10740 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
10741
10742 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
10743 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
10744 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
10745 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
10746
10747 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10748
10749 @example
10750 (vxgdb)
10751 @end example
10752
10753 @menu
10754 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
10755 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
10756 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
10757 @end menu
10758
10759 @node VxWorks Connection
10760 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
10761
10762 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10763 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
10764
10765 @example
10766 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
10767 @end example
10768
10769 @need 750
10770 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10771
10772 @smallexample
10773 Attaching remote machine across net...
10774 Connected to tt.
10775 @end smallexample
10776
10777 @need 1000
10778 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10779 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
10780 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10781 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10782 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
10783
10784 @example
10785 prog.o: No such file or directory.
10786 @end example
10787
10788 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10789 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10790 command again.
10791
10792 @node VxWorks Download
10793 @subsubsection VxWorks download
10794
10795 @cindex download to VxWorks
10796 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10797 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10798 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10799 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10800 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10801 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10802 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10803 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10804 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10805 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10806 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10807 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
10808 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10809 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
10810 program, type this on VxWorks:
10811
10812 @example
10813 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
10814 @end example
10815
10816 @noindent
10817 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10818
10819 @example
10820 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
10821 (vxgdb) load prog.o
10822 @end example
10823
10824 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
10825
10826 @smallexample
10827 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
10828 @end smallexample
10829
10830 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
10831 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
10832 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
10833 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
10834 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
10835 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
10836 table.)
10837
10838 @node VxWorks Attach
10839 @subsubsection Running tasks
10840
10841 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
10842 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
10843 follows:
10844
10845 @example
10846 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
10847 @end example
10848
10849 @noindent
10850 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
10851 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
10852 the time of attachment.
10853
10854 @node Embedded Processors
10855 @section Embedded Processors
10856
10857 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
10858 configurations.
10859
10860
10861 @c OBSOLETE * A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
10862 @menu
10863 * ARM:: ARM
10864 * H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
10865 * H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
10866 * i960:: Intel i960
10867 * M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
10868 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
10869 * M88K:: Motorola M88K
10870 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
10871 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
10872 * PowerPC: PowerPC
10873 * SH:: Hitachi SH
10874 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
10875 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
10876 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
10877 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
10878 @end menu
10879
10880 @c OBSOLETE @node A29K Embedded
10881 @c OBSOLETE @subsection AMD A29K Embedded
10882 @c OBSOLETE
10883 @c OBSOLETE @menu
10884 @c OBSOLETE * A29K UDI::
10885 @c OBSOLETE * A29K EB29K::
10886 @c OBSOLETE * Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
10887 @c OBSOLETE * gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
10888 @c OBSOLETE * Remote Log:: Remote log
10889 @c OBSOLETE @end menu
10890 @c OBSOLETE
10891 @c OBSOLETE @table @code
10892 @c OBSOLETE
10893 @c OBSOLETE @kindex target adapt
10894 @c OBSOLETE @item target adapt @var{dev}
10895 @c OBSOLETE Adapt monitor for A29K.
10896 @c OBSOLETE
10897 @c OBSOLETE @kindex target amd-eb
10898 @c OBSOLETE @item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
10899 @c OBSOLETE @cindex AMD EB29K
10900 @c OBSOLETE Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
10901 @c OBSOLETE @var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
10902 @c OBSOLETE @var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
10903 @c OBSOLETE name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
10904 @c OBSOLETE @xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
10905 @c OBSOLETE
10906 @c OBSOLETE @end table
10907 @c OBSOLETE
10908 @c OBSOLETE @node A29K UDI
10909 @c OBSOLETE @subsubsection A29K UDI
10910 @c OBSOLETE
10911 @c OBSOLETE @cindex UDI
10912 @c OBSOLETE @cindex AMD29K via UDI
10913 @c OBSOLETE
10914 @c OBSOLETE @value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
10915 @c OBSOLETE protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
10916 @c OBSOLETE configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
10917 @c OBSOLETE program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
10918 @c OBSOLETE use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
10919 @c OBSOLETE @code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
10920 @c OBSOLETE
10921 @c OBSOLETE @table @code
10922 @c OBSOLETE @item target udi @var{keyword}
10923 @c OBSOLETE @kindex udi
10924 @c OBSOLETE Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
10925 @c OBSOLETE @var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
10926 @c OBSOLETE This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
10927 @c OBSOLETE connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
10928 @c OBSOLETE working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
10929 @c OBSOLETE to its pathname.
10930 @c OBSOLETE @end table
10931 @c OBSOLETE
10932 @c OBSOLETE @node A29K EB29K
10933 @c OBSOLETE @subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
10934 @c OBSOLETE
10935 @c OBSOLETE @cindex EB29K board
10936 @c OBSOLETE @cindex running 29K programs
10937 @c OBSOLETE
10938 @c OBSOLETE AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
10939 @c OBSOLETE with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
10940 @c OBSOLETE term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
10941 @c OBSOLETE @value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
10942 @c OBSOLETE must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
10943 @c OBSOLETE board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
10944 @c OBSOLETE assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
10945 @c OBSOLETE @file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
10946 @c OBSOLETE
10947 @c OBSOLETE @node Comms (EB29K)
10948 @c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Communications setup
10949 @c OBSOLETE
10950 @c OBSOLETE The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
10951 @c OBSOLETE in DOS on the PC:
10952 @c OBSOLETE
10953 @c OBSOLETE @example
10954 @c OBSOLETE C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
10955 @c OBSOLETE @end example
10956 @c OBSOLETE
10957 @c OBSOLETE @noindent
10958 @c OBSOLETE This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
10959 @c OBSOLETE bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
10960 @c OBSOLETE you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
10961 @c OBSOLETE end of the connection as well.
10962 @c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
10963 @c OBSOLETE @c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10964 @c OBSOLETE @c
10965 @c OBSOLETE @c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
10966 @c OBSOLETE @c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
10967 @c OBSOLETE @c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
10968 @c OBSOLETE @c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
10969 @c OBSOLETE @c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
10970 @c OBSOLETE
10971 @c OBSOLETE To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
10972 @c OBSOLETE the following at the DOS console:
10973 @c OBSOLETE
10974 @c OBSOLETE @example
10975 @c OBSOLETE C:\> CTTY com1
10976 @c OBSOLETE @end example
10977 @c OBSOLETE
10978 @c OBSOLETE @noindent
10979 @c OBSOLETE (Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
10980 @c OBSOLETE the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
10981 @c OBSOLETE had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
10982 @c OBSOLETE
10983 @c OBSOLETE From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
10984 @c OBSOLETE @code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
10985 @c OBSOLETE
10986 @c OBSOLETE @example
10987 @c OBSOLETE cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
10988 @c OBSOLETE @end example
10989 @c OBSOLETE
10990 @c OBSOLETE @noindent
10991 @c OBSOLETE The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
10992 @c OBSOLETE serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
10993 @c OBSOLETE may look something like the following:
10994 @c OBSOLETE
10995 @c OBSOLETE @example
10996 @c OBSOLETE tip -9600 /dev/ttya
10997 @c OBSOLETE @end example
10998 @c OBSOLETE
10999 @c OBSOLETE @noindent
11000 @c OBSOLETE Your system may require a different name where we show
11001 @c OBSOLETE @file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
11002 @c OBSOLETE parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
11003 @c OBSOLETE @code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
11004 @c OBSOLETE system table @file{/etc/remote}.
11005 @c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
11006 @c OBSOLETE @c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
11007 @c OBSOLETE @c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
11008 @c OBSOLETE @c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
11009 @c OBSOLETE @c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
11010 @c OBSOLETE @c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
11011 @c OBSOLETE @c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11012 @c OBSOLETE @c
11013 @c OBSOLETE @c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
11014 @c OBSOLETE @c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
11015 @c OBSOLETE @c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
11016 @c OBSOLETE
11017 @c OBSOLETE @kindex EBMON
11018 @c OBSOLETE Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
11019 @c OBSOLETE directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
11020 @c OBSOLETE start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
11021 @c OBSOLETE with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
11022 @c OBSOLETE @code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
11023 @c OBSOLETE @code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
11024 @c OBSOLETE
11025 @c OBSOLETE @example
11026 @c OBSOLETE C:\> G:
11027 @c OBSOLETE
11028 @c OBSOLETE G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
11029 @c OBSOLETE
11030 @c OBSOLETE G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
11031 @c OBSOLETE Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
11032 @c OBSOLETE Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
11033 @c OBSOLETE Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
11034 @c OBSOLETE
11035 @c OBSOLETE Enter '?' or 'H' for help
11036 @c OBSOLETE
11037 @c OBSOLETE PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
11038 @c OBSOLETE I/O Base = 0x208
11039 @c OBSOLETE Memory Base = 0xd0000
11040 @c OBSOLETE
11041 @c OBSOLETE Data Memory Size = 2048KB
11042 @c OBSOLETE Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
11043 @c OBSOLETE Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
11044 @c OBSOLETE
11045 @c OBSOLETE PageSize = 0x400
11046 @c OBSOLETE Register Stack Size = 0x800
11047 @c OBSOLETE Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
11048 @c OBSOLETE
11049 @c OBSOLETE CPU PRL = 0x3
11050 @c OBSOLETE Am29027 Available = No
11051 @c OBSOLETE Byte Write Available = Yes
11052 @c OBSOLETE
11053 @c OBSOLETE # ~.
11054 @c OBSOLETE @end example
11055 @c OBSOLETE
11056 @c OBSOLETE Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
11057 @c OBSOLETE typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
11058 @c OBSOLETE running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
11059 @c OBSOLETE
11060 @c OBSOLETE For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
11061 @c OBSOLETE way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
11062 @c OBSOLETE system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
11063 @c OBSOLETE PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
11064 @c OBSOLETE something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
11065 @c OBSOLETE other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
11066 @c OBSOLETE from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
11067 @c OBSOLETE serial line.
11068 @c OBSOLETE
11069 @c OBSOLETE @node gdb-EB29K
11070 @c OBSOLETE @subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
11071 @c OBSOLETE
11072 @c OBSOLETE Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
11073 @c OBSOLETE program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
11074 @c OBSOLETE name of your 29K program:
11075 @c OBSOLETE
11076 @c OBSOLETE @example
11077 @c OBSOLETE cd /usr/joe/work29k
11078 @c OBSOLETE @value{GDBP} myfoo
11079 @c OBSOLETE @end example
11080 @c OBSOLETE
11081 @c OBSOLETE @need 500
11082 @c OBSOLETE Now you can use the @code{target} command:
11083 @c OBSOLETE
11084 @c OBSOLETE @example
11085 @c OBSOLETE target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
11086 @c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
11087 @c OBSOLETE @c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
11088 @c OBSOLETE @c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11089 @c OBSOLETE @end example
11090 @c OBSOLETE
11091 @c OBSOLETE @noindent
11092 @c OBSOLETE In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
11093 @c OBSOLETE @file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
11094 @c OBSOLETE @code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
11095 @c OBSOLETE In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
11096 @c OBSOLETE a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
11097 @c OBSOLETE the name on the Unix side.
11098 @c OBSOLETE
11099 @c OBSOLETE At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
11100 @c OBSOLETE to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
11101 @c OBSOLETE @code{run}.
11102 @c OBSOLETE
11103 @c OBSOLETE To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
11104 @c OBSOLETE command.
11105 @c OBSOLETE
11106 @c OBSOLETE To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
11107 @c OBSOLETE once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
11108 @c OBSOLETE @code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
11109 @c OBSOLETE @code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
11110 @c OBSOLETE Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
11111 @c OBSOLETE and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
11112 @c OBSOLETE
11113 @c OBSOLETE @node Remote Log
11114 @c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Remote log
11115 @c OBSOLETE @cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
11116 @c OBSOLETE @cindex log file for EB29K
11117 @c OBSOLETE
11118 @c OBSOLETE The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
11119 @c OBSOLETE current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
11120 @c OBSOLETE @file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
11121 @c OBSOLETE of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
11122 @c OBSOLETE another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
11123 @c OBSOLETE unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
11124
11125 @node ARM
11126 @subsection ARM
11127
11128 @table @code
11129
11130 @kindex target rdi
11131 @item target rdi @var{dev}
11132 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11133 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11134 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11135
11136 @kindex target rdp
11137 @item target rdp @var{dev}
11138 ARM Demon monitor.
11139
11140 @end table
11141
11142 @node H8/300
11143 @subsection Hitachi H8/300
11144
11145 @table @code
11146
11147 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11148 @item target hms @var{dev}
11149 A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11150 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11151 line and the communications speed used.
11152
11153 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11154 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
11155 E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11156
11157 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11158 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11159 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
11160 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11161 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11162
11163 @end table
11164
11165 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11166 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11167 @cindex download to Hitachi SH
11168 @cindex Hitachi SH download
11169 When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11170 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11171 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11172 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11173
11174 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11175 Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11176
11177 @enumerate
11178 @item
11179 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11180 for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11181 emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11182 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11183 H8/300, or H8/500.)
11184
11185 @item
11186 what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11187 serial device available on your host is the default).
11188
11189 @item
11190 what speed to use over the serial device.
11191 @end enumerate
11192
11193 @menu
11194 * Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11195 * Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11196 * Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11197 @end menu
11198
11199 @node Hitachi Boards
11200 @subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11201
11202 @c only for Unix hosts
11203 @kindex device
11204 @cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11205 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11206 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11207 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11208 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11209
11210 @kindex speed
11211 @cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11212 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11213 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11214 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11215 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11216 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11217
11218 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11219 use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11220 use a DOS host,
11221 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11222 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11223 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11224 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11225
11226 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11227 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11228 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11229 the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11230
11231 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11232 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11233 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11234 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11235 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11236 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11237 @code{COM2}.
11238
11239 @example
11240 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11241 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11242
11243 Resident portion of MODE loaded
11244
11245 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11246
11247 @end example
11248
11249 @quotation
11250 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11251 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11252 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11253 your development board.
11254 @end quotation
11255
11256 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11257 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11258 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11259 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11260 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11261 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11262 cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11263 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11264 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11265 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11266 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11267 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11268 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11269
11270 @smallexample
11271 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11272 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11273 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11274 the conditions.
11275 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11276 for details.
11277 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11278 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
11279 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11280 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11281 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11282 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11283 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11284 @end smallexample
11285
11286 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11287 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11288 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11289 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11290 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11291 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11292
11293 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11294 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11295 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11296
11297 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11298 @itemize @bullet
11299 @item
11300 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11301 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11302
11303 @item
11304 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11305 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11306 to detect program completion.
11307 @end itemize
11308
11309 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11310 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11311
11312 @node Hitachi ICE
11313 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11314
11315 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11316 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11317 Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11318 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11319
11320 @table @code
11321 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11322 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11323 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11324 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11325 (for example, @samp{9600}).
11326
11327 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11328 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11329 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11330 @end table
11331
11332 @node Hitachi Special
11333 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11334
11335 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11336
11337 @table @code
11338
11339 @kindex set machine
11340 @kindex show machine
11341 @item set machine h8300
11342 @itemx set machine h8300h
11343 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11344 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11345 to check which variant is currently in effect.
11346
11347 @end table
11348
11349 @node H8/500
11350 @subsection H8/500
11351
11352 @table @code
11353
11354 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
11355 @cindex memory models, H8/500
11356 @item set memory @var{mod}
11357 @itemx show memory
11358 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11359 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11360 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11361 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
11362
11363 @end table
11364
11365 @node i960
11366 @subsection Intel i960
11367
11368 @table @code
11369
11370 @kindex target mon960
11371 @item target mon960 @var{dev}
11372 MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
11373
11374 @kindex target nindy
11375 @item target nindy @var{devicename}
11376 An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11377 the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11378 @file{/dev/ttya}.
11379
11380 @end table
11381
11382 @cindex Nindy
11383 @cindex i960
11384 @dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11385 @value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11386 tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11387
11388 @itemize @bullet
11389 @item
11390 Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11391 Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
11392
11393 @item
11394 By responding to a prompt on startup;
11395
11396 @item
11397 By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11398 session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11399
11400 @end itemize
11401
11402 @cindex download to Nindy-960
11403 With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11404 downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11405 @value{GDBN}.
11406
11407 @menu
11408 * Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11409 * Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11410 * Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11411 @end menu
11412
11413 @node Nindy Startup
11414 @subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11415
11416 If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11417 options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11418 reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11419
11420 @example
11421 Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
11422 @end example
11423
11424 @noindent
11425 Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11426 identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11427 simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11428 with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11429 use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11430
11431 @node Nindy Options
11432 @subsubsection Options for Nindy
11433
11434 These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11435 Nindy-960 board attached:
11436
11437 @table @code
11438 @item -r @var{port}
11439 Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11440 to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11441 configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11442 @var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11443 device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11444 suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11445
11446 @item -O
11447 (An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11448 the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11449 This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11450 target architecture.
11451
11452 @quotation
11453 @emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11454 connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11455 fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11456 attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11457 this process with an interrupt.
11458 @end quotation
11459
11460 @item -brk
11461 Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11462 system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11463
11464 @quotation
11465 @emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11466 requires; it only works with a few boards.
11467 @end quotation
11468 @end table
11469
11470 The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11471 port.
11472
11473 @c @group
11474 @node Nindy Reset
11475 @subsubsection Nindy reset command
11476
11477 @table @code
11478 @item reset
11479 @kindex reset
11480 For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11481 system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11482 circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11483 a break is detected.
11484 @end table
11485 @c @end group
11486
11487 @node M32R/D
11488 @subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11489
11490 @table @code
11491
11492 @kindex target m32r
11493 @item target m32r @var{dev}
11494 Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11495
11496 @end table
11497
11498 @node M68K
11499 @subsection M68k
11500
11501 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11502 target command for the following ROM monitors.
11503
11504 @table @code
11505
11506 @kindex target abug
11507 @item target abug @var{dev}
11508 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11509
11510 @kindex target cpu32bug
11511 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11512 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11513
11514 @kindex target dbug
11515 @item target dbug @var{dev}
11516 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11517
11518 @kindex target est
11519 @item target est @var{dev}
11520 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11521
11522 @kindex target rom68k
11523 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
11524 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11525
11526 @end table
11527
11528 If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11529 instead have only a single special target command:
11530
11531 @table @code
11532
11533 @kindex target es1800
11534 @item target es1800 @var{dev}
11535 ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11536
11537 @end table
11538
11539 [context?]
11540
11541 @table @code
11542
11543 @kindex target rombug
11544 @item target rombug @var{dev}
11545 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11546
11547 @end table
11548
11549 @node M88K
11550 @subsection M88K
11551
11552 @table @code
11553
11554 @kindex target bug
11555 @item target bug @var{dev}
11556 BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
11557
11558 @end table
11559
11560 @node MIPS Embedded
11561 @subsection MIPS Embedded
11562
11563 @cindex MIPS boards
11564 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11565 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11566 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
11567
11568 @need 1000
11569 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
11570
11571 @table @code
11572 @item target mips @var{port}
11573 @kindex target mips @var{port}
11574 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11575 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11576 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11577 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11578 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11579 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
11580
11581 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11582 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11583 debugger:
11584
11585 @example
11586 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11587 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11588 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11589 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11590 (@value{GDBP}) run
11591 @end example
11592
11593 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11594 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11595 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11596 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11597 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11598
11599 @item target pmon @var{port}
11600 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
11601 PMON ROM monitor.
11602
11603 @item target ddb @var{port}
11604 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
11605 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
11606
11607 @item target lsi @var{port}
11608 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
11609 LSI variant of PMON.
11610
11611 @kindex target r3900
11612 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
11613 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
11614
11615 @kindex target array
11616 @item target array @var{dev}
11617 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
11618
11619 @end table
11620
11621
11622 @noindent
11623 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
11624
11625 @table @code
11626 @item set processor @var{args}
11627 @itemx show processor
11628 @kindex set processor @var{args}
11629 @kindex show processor
11630 Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11631 processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11632 For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11633 to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11634 Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11635 is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11636 @value{GDBN} is using.
11637
11638 @item set mipsfpu double
11639 @itemx set mipsfpu single
11640 @itemx set mipsfpu none
11641 @itemx show mipsfpu
11642 @kindex set mipsfpu
11643 @kindex show mipsfpu
11644 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
11645 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11646 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11647 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11648 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11649 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11650 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11651 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11652 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11653 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11654 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11655 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11656 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
11657
11658 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11659 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11660 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
11661
11662 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11663 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
11664
11665 @item set remotedebug @var{n}
11666 @itemx show remotedebug
11667 @kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11668 @kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11669 @cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11670 @cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11671 @c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11672 @c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11673 You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11674 by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11675 @samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11676 to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11677 at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
11678
11679 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
11680 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11681 @itemx show timeout
11682 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
11683 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11684 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11685 @kindex set timeout
11686 @kindex show timeout
11687 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
11688 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
11689 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11690 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11691 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11692 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11693 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11694 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11695 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11696 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
11697
11698 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11699 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11700 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11701 to run before stopping.
11702 @end table
11703
11704 @node PowerPC
11705 @subsection PowerPC
11706
11707 @table @code
11708
11709 @kindex target dink32
11710 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
11711 DINK32 ROM monitor.
11712
11713 @kindex target ppcbug
11714 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11715 @kindex target ppcbug1
11716 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11717 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
11718
11719 @kindex target sds
11720 @item target sds @var{dev}
11721 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11722
11723 @end table
11724
11725 @node PA
11726 @subsection HP PA Embedded
11727
11728 @table @code
11729
11730 @kindex target op50n
11731 @item target op50n @var{dev}
11732 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11733
11734 @kindex target w89k
11735 @item target w89k @var{dev}
11736 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
11737
11738 @end table
11739
11740 @node SH
11741 @subsection Hitachi SH
11742
11743 @table @code
11744
11745 @kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11746 @item target hms @var{dev}
11747 A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11748 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11749 the communications speed used.
11750
11751 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11752 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
11753 E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
11754
11755 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11756 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
11757 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
11758 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
11759 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11760
11761 @end table
11762
11763 @node Sparclet
11764 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
11765
11766 @cindex Sparclet
11767
11768 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11769 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
11770 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11771 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
11772 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
11773
11774 @table @code
11775 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
11776 @kindex remotetimeout
11777 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11778 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11779 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
11780 @end table
11781
11782 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
11783 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
11784 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
11785 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
11786 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
11787
11788 @example
11789 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11790 @end example
11791
11792 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
11793
11794 @example
11795 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11796 @end example
11797
11798 @cindex running, on Sparclet
11799 Once you have set
11800 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11801 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
11802 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
11803
11804 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11805
11806 @example
11807 (gdbslet)
11808 @end example
11809
11810 @menu
11811 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11812 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11813 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
11814 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
11815 @end menu
11816
11817 @node Sparclet File
11818 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
11819
11820 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
11821
11822 @example
11823 (gdbslet) file prog
11824 @end example
11825
11826 @need 1000
11827 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11828 @value{GDBN} locates
11829 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11830 path.
11831 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11832 files will be searched as well.
11833 @value{GDBN} locates
11834 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11835 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11836 If it fails
11837 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
11838
11839 @example
11840 prog: No such file or directory.
11841 @end example
11842
11843 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
11844 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
11845 @code{target} command again.
11846
11847 @node Sparclet Connection
11848 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
11849
11850 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11851 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
11852
11853 @example
11854 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11855 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
11856 main () at ../prog.c:3
11857 @end example
11858
11859 @need 750
11860 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11861
11862 @example
11863 Connected to ttya.
11864 @end example
11865
11866 @node Sparclet Download
11867 @subsubsection Sparclet download
11868
11869 @cindex download to Sparclet
11870 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
11871 you can use the @value{GDBN}
11872 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11873 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11874 command.
11875 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
11876 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
11877 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11878 of each of the file's sections.
11879 For instance, if the program
11880 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
11881 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11882
11883 @example
11884 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
11885 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
11886 @end example
11887
11888 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
11889 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
11890 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
11891
11892 @node Sparclet Execution
11893 @subsubsection Running and debugging
11894
11895 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
11896 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
11897 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
11898 manual for the list of commands.
11899
11900 @example
11901 (gdbslet) b main
11902 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
11903 (gdbslet) run
11904 Starting program: prog
11905 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
11906 3 char *symarg = 0;
11907 (gdbslet) step
11908 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
11909 (gdbslet)
11910 @end example
11911
11912 @node Sparclite
11913 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
11914
11915 @table @code
11916
11917 @kindex target sparclite
11918 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
11919 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
11920 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
11921 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
11922 remote protocol.
11923
11924 @end table
11925
11926 @node ST2000
11927 @subsection Tandem ST2000
11928
11929 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
11930 STDBUG protocol.
11931
11932 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
11933 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
11934
11935 @example
11936 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
11937 @end example
11938
11939 @noindent
11940 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
11941 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
11942 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
11943 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
11944 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11945
11946 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
11947 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
11948 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
11949 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
11950 available on your host computer.
11951 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
11952 @c basically hearsay.
11953
11954 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
11955 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
11956 environment:
11957
11958 @table @code
11959 @item st2000 @var{command}
11960 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
11961 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
11962 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
11963 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
11964 manual for available commands.
11965
11966 @item connect
11967 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
11968 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
11969 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
11970 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
11971 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
11972 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
11973 @end table
11974
11975 @node Z8000
11976 @subsection Zilog Z8000
11977
11978 @cindex Z8000
11979 @cindex simulator, Z8000
11980 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
11981
11982 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
11983 a Z8000 simulator.
11984
11985 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
11986 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
11987 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
11988 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
11989
11990 @table @code
11991 @item target sim @var{args}
11992 @kindex sim
11993 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
11994 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
11995 options, specify them via @var{args}.
11996 @end table
11997
11998 @noindent
11999 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12000 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12001 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12002 to run your program, and so on.
12003
12004 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12005 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12006 additional items of information as specially named registers:
12007
12008 @table @code
12009
12010 @item cycles
12011 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12012
12013 @item insts
12014 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12015
12016 @item time
12017 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12018
12019 @end table
12020
12021 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12022 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12023 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12024 simulated clock ticks.
12025
12026 @node Architectures
12027 @section Architectures
12028
12029 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12030 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
12031
12032 @menu
12033 * A29K::
12034 * Alpha::
12035 * MIPS::
12036 @end menu
12037
12038 @node A29K
12039 @subsection A29K
12040
12041 @table @code
12042
12043 @kindex set rstack_high_address
12044 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
12045 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
12046 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12047 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12048 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12049 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12050 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12051 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12052 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12053 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12054 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12055 hexadecimal.
12056
12057 @kindex show rstack_high_address
12058 @item show rstack_high_address
12059 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12060 processors.
12061
12062 @end table
12063
12064 @node Alpha
12065 @subsection Alpha
12066
12067 See the following section.
12068
12069 @node MIPS
12070 @subsection MIPS
12071
12072 @cindex stack on Alpha
12073 @cindex stack on MIPS
12074 @cindex Alpha stack
12075 @cindex MIPS stack
12076 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12077 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12078 find the beginning of a function.
12079
12080 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12081 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12082 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12083 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12084 commands:
12085
12086 @table @code
12087 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12088 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12089 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12090 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12091 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12092 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12093 and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12094
12095 @item show heuristic-fence-post
12096 Display the current limit.
12097 @end table
12098
12099 @noindent
12100 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12101 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12102
12103
12104 @node Controlling GDB
12105 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12106
12107 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12108 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12109 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12110 described here.
12111
12112 @menu
12113 * Prompt:: Prompt
12114 * Editing:: Command editing
12115 * History:: Command history
12116 * Screen Size:: Screen size
12117 * Numbers:: Numbers
12118 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12119 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12120 @end menu
12121
12122 @node Prompt
12123 @section Prompt
12124
12125 @cindex prompt
12126
12127 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12128 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12129 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12130 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12131 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12132 which one you are talking to.
12133
12134 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12135 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12136 or a prompt that does not.
12137
12138 @table @code
12139 @kindex set prompt
12140 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12141 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12142
12143 @kindex show prompt
12144 @item show prompt
12145 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12146 @end table
12147
12148 @node Editing
12149 @section Command editing
12150 @cindex readline
12151 @cindex command line editing
12152
12153 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12154 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12155 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12156 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12157 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12158 debugging sessions.
12159
12160 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12161 command @code{set}.
12162
12163 @table @code
12164 @kindex set editing
12165 @cindex editing
12166 @item set editing
12167 @itemx set editing on
12168 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12169
12170 @item set editing off
12171 Disable command line editing.
12172
12173 @kindex show editing
12174 @item show editing
12175 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12176 @end table
12177
12178 @node History
12179 @section Command history
12180
12181 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12182 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12183 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12184 history facility.
12185
12186 @table @code
12187 @cindex history substitution
12188 @cindex history file
12189 @kindex set history filename
12190 @kindex GDBHISTFILE
12191 @item set history filename @var{fname}
12192 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12193 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12194 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12195 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12196 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12197 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12198 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12199 is not set.
12200
12201 @cindex history save
12202 @kindex set history save
12203 @item set history save
12204 @itemx set history save on
12205 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12206 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12207
12208 @item set history save off
12209 Stop recording command history in a file.
12210
12211 @cindex history size
12212 @kindex set history size
12213 @item set history size @var{size}
12214 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12215 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12216 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12217 @end table
12218
12219 @cindex history expansion
12220 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12221 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12222 @xref{Event Designators}.
12223 @end ifset
12224
12225 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12226 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12227 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12228 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12229 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12230 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12231 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12232
12233 The commands to control history expansion are:
12234
12235 @table @code
12236 @kindex set history expansion
12237 @item set history expansion on
12238 @itemx set history expansion
12239 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
12240
12241 @item set history expansion off
12242 Disable history expansion.
12243
12244 The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12245 editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12246 or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12247 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12248 @xref{Command Line Editing}.
12249 @end ifset
12250
12251 @c @group
12252 @kindex show history
12253 @item show history
12254 @itemx show history filename
12255 @itemx show history save
12256 @itemx show history size
12257 @itemx show history expansion
12258 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12259 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12260 @c @end group
12261 @end table
12262
12263 @table @code
12264 @kindex shows
12265 @item show commands
12266 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12267
12268 @item show commands @var{n}
12269 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12270
12271 @item show commands +
12272 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12273 @end table
12274
12275 @node Screen Size
12276 @section Screen size
12277 @cindex size of screen
12278 @cindex pauses in output
12279
12280 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12281 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12282 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12283 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12284 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12285 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12286 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12287 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12288
12289 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12290 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12291 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12292 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12293 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12294 width} commands:
12295
12296 @table @code
12297 @kindex set height
12298 @kindex set width
12299 @kindex show width
12300 @kindex show height
12301 @item set height @var{lpp}
12302 @itemx show height
12303 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
12304 @itemx show width
12305 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12306 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12307 commands display the current settings.
12308
12309 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12310 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12311 file or to an editor buffer.
12312
12313 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12314 from wrapping its output.
12315 @end table
12316
12317 @node Numbers
12318 @section Numbers
12319 @cindex number representation
12320 @cindex entering numbers
12321
12322 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12323 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12324 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12325 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12326 default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12327 numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12328 change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12329 radix} command.
12330
12331 @table @code
12332 @kindex set input-radix
12333 @item set input-radix @var{base}
12334 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12335 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12336 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12337 example, any of
12338
12339 @smallexample
12340 set radix 012
12341 set radix 10.
12342 set radix 0xa
12343 @end smallexample
12344
12345 @noindent
12346 sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12347 leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
12348
12349 @kindex set output-radix
12350 @item set output-radix @var{base}
12351 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12352 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12353 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
12354
12355 @kindex show input-radix
12356 @item show input-radix
12357 Display the current default base for numeric input.
12358
12359 @kindex show output-radix
12360 @item show output-radix
12361 Display the current default base for numeric display.
12362 @end table
12363
12364 @node Messages/Warnings
12365 @section Optional warnings and messages
12366
12367 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12368 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12369 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12370 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
12371
12372 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12373 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12374 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
12375
12376 @table @code
12377 @kindex set verbose
12378 @item set verbose on
12379 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12380
12381 @item set verbose off
12382 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12383
12384 @kindex show verbose
12385 @item show verbose
12386 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12387 @end table
12388
12389 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12390 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12391 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12392 symbol files}).
12393
12394 @table @code
12395
12396 @kindex set complaints
12397 @item set complaints @var{limit}
12398 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12399 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12400 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12401 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
12402
12403 @kindex show complaints
12404 @item show complaints
12405 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
12406
12407 @end table
12408
12409 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12410 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12411 you try to run a program which is already running:
12412
12413 @example
12414 (@value{GDBP}) run
12415 The program being debugged has been started already.
12416 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
12417 @end example
12418
12419 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12420 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
12421
12422 @table @code
12423
12424 @kindex set confirm
12425 @cindex flinching
12426 @cindex confirmation
12427 @cindex stupid questions
12428 @item set confirm off
12429 Disables confirmation requests.
12430
12431 @item set confirm on
12432 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
12433
12434 @kindex show confirm
12435 @item show confirm
12436 Displays state of confirmation requests.
12437
12438 @end table
12439
12440 @node Debugging Output
12441 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
12442 @table @code
12443 @kindex set debug arch
12444 @item set debug arch
12445 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12446 @kindex show debug arch
12447 @item show debug arch
12448 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12449 @kindex set debug event
12450 @item set debug event
12451 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12452 default is off.
12453 @kindex show debug event
12454 @item show debug event
12455 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12456 info.
12457 @kindex set debug expression
12458 @item set debug expression
12459 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12460 default is off.
12461 @kindex show debug expression
12462 @item show debug expression
12463 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12464 debugging info.
12465 @kindex set debug overload
12466 @item set debug overload
12467 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12468 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12469 is off.
12470 @kindex show debug overload
12471 @item show debug overload
12472 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12473 debugging info.
12474 @kindex set debug remote
12475 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12476 @cindex serial connections, debugging
12477 @item set debug remote
12478 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12479 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12480 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12481 @kindex show debug remote
12482 @item show debug remote
12483 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12484 @kindex set debug serial
12485 @item set debug serial
12486 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12487 default is off.
12488 @kindex show debug serial
12489 @item show debug serial
12490 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12491 info.
12492 @kindex set debug target
12493 @item set debug target
12494 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12495 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12496 default is off.
12497 @kindex show debug target
12498 @item show debug target
12499 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12500 info.
12501 @kindex set debug varobj
12502 @item set debug varobj
12503 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12504 info. The default is off.
12505 @kindex show debug varobj
12506 @item show debug varobj
12507 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12508 debugging info.
12509 @end table
12510
12511 @node Sequences
12512 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
12513
12514 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
12515 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12516 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12517 files.
12518
12519 @menu
12520 * Define:: User-defined commands
12521 * Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12522 * Command Files:: Command files
12523 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
12524 @end menu
12525
12526 @node Define
12527 @section User-defined commands
12528
12529 @cindex user-defined command
12530 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12531 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12532 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12533 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12534 via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
12535
12536 @smallexample
12537 define adder
12538 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12539 @end smallexample
12540
12541 @noindent
12542 To execute the command use:
12543
12544 @smallexample
12545 adder 1 2 3
12546 @end smallexample
12547
12548 @noindent
12549 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
12550 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
12551 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12552 functions calls.
12553
12554 @table @code
12555
12556 @kindex define
12557 @item define @var{commandname}
12558 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12559 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
12560
12561 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12562 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12563 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12564
12565 @kindex if
12566 @kindex else
12567 @item if
12568 Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12569 It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12570 only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12571 There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12572 by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12573 was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12574
12575 @kindex while
12576 @item while
12577 The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12578 which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12579 execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12580 The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12581 evaluates to true.
12582
12583 @kindex document
12584 @item document @var{commandname}
12585 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
12586 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12587 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12588 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12589 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
12590 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
12591
12592 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12593 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12594 does not change the documentation.
12595
12596 @kindex help user-defined
12597 @item help user-defined
12598 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12599 (if any) for each.
12600
12601 @kindex show user
12602 @item show user
12603 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
12604 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12605 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
12606 definitions for all user-defined commands.
12607
12608 @end table
12609
12610 When user-defined commands are executed, the
12611 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12612 stops execution of the user-defined command.
12613
12614 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
12615 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12616 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
12617 messages when used in a user-defined command.
12618
12619 @node Hooks
12620 @section User-defined command hooks
12621 @cindex command hooks
12622 @cindex hooks, for commands
12623 @cindex hooks, pre-command
12624
12625 @kindex hook
12626 @kindex hook-
12627 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
12628 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12629 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12630 before that command.
12631
12632 @cindex hooks, post-command
12633 @kindex hookpost
12634 @kindex hookpost-
12635 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12636 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12637 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12638 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12639 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
12640
12641 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12642 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
12643
12644 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12645 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
12646
12647 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
12648 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12649 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12650 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12651 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
12652
12653 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12654 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12655 you could define:
12656
12657 @example
12658 define hook-stop
12659 handle SIGALRM nopass
12660 end
12661
12662 define hook-run
12663 handle SIGALRM pass
12664 end
12665
12666 define hook-continue
12667 handle SIGLARM pass
12668 end
12669 @end example
12670
12671 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12672 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12673 you could define:
12674
12675 @example
12676 define hook-echo
12677 echo <<<---
12678 end
12679
12680 define hookpost-echo
12681 echo --->>>\n
12682 end
12683
12684 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12685 <<<---Hello World--->>>
12686 (@value{GDBP})
12687
12688 @end example
12689
12690 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12691 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12692 name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12693 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12694 @c or not?
12695 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12696 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12697 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
12698
12699 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12700 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
12701
12702 @node Command Files
12703 @section Command files
12704
12705 @cindex command files
12706 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12707 commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12708 An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
12709 the last command, as it would from the terminal.
12710
12711 @cindex init file
12712 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
12713 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
12714 When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
12715 @dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
12716 port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
12717 limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
12718 During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
12719
12720 @enumerate
12721 @item
12722 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12723 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12724 @code{HOME} environment variable.}.
12725
12726 @item
12727 Processes command line options and operands.
12728
12729 @item
12730 Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
12731
12732 @item
12733 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12734 @end enumerate
12735
12736 The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12737 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12738 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12739 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
12740
12741 @cindex init file name
12742 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12743 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12744 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12745 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12746 environments with special init file names:
12747
12748 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
12749 @itemize @bullet
12750 @item
12751 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
12752
12753 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
12754 @item
12755 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
12756
12757 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
12758 @item
12759 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
12760 @end itemize
12761
12762 You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12763 @code{source} command:
12764
12765 @table @code
12766 @kindex source
12767 @item source @var{filename}
12768 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
12769 @end table
12770
12771 The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
12772 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
12773 of the command file.
12774
12775 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12776 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12777 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12778 when called from command files.
12779
12780 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
12781 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
12782 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
12783 not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
12784 the next command.
12785
12786 @example
12787 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
12788 @end example
12789
12790 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
12791 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
12792 would be directed to @file{log}.
12793
12794 @node Output
12795 @section Commands for controlled output
12796
12797 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
12798 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
12799 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
12800 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
12801 want.
12802
12803 @table @code
12804 @kindex echo
12805 @item echo @var{text}
12806 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
12807 @c because it is not in ANSI.
12808 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
12809 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
12810 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
12811 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
12812 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
12813 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
12814 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
12815 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12816 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
12817
12818 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
12819 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
12820
12821 @example
12822 echo This is some text\n\
12823 which is continued\n\
12824 onto several lines.\n
12825 @end example
12826
12827 produces the same output as
12828
12829 @example
12830 echo This is some text\n
12831 echo which is continued\n
12832 echo onto several lines.\n
12833 @end example
12834
12835 @kindex output
12836 @item output @var{expression}
12837 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
12838 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
12839 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
12840 on expressions.
12841
12842 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
12843 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
12844 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
12845 formats}, for more information.
12846
12847 @kindex printf
12848 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
12849 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
12850 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
12851 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
12852 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
12853 subroutine
12854 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
12855 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
12856 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
12857 @c supported.
12858
12859 @example
12860 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
12861 @end example
12862
12863 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
12864
12865 @smallexample
12866 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
12867 @end smallexample
12868
12869 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
12870 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
12871 letter.
12872 @end table
12873
12874 @node TUI
12875 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
12876 @cindex TUI
12877
12878 @menu
12879 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
12880 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
12881 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
12882 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
12883 @end menu
12884
12885 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
12886 is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
12887 to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
12888 and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
12889 The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
12890 with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
12891
12892 @node TUI Overview
12893 @section TUI overview
12894
12895 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
12896 @value{GDBN} runs:
12897
12898 @itemize @bullet
12899 @item
12900 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
12901 windows on the terminal.
12902
12903 @item
12904 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
12905 the TUI.
12906 @end itemize
12907
12908 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
12909 on the terminal:
12910
12911 @table @emph
12912 @item command
12913 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
12914 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
12915 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
12916 window is always visible.
12917
12918 @item source
12919 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
12920 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
12921 The current program position is shown with the @samp{>} marker and
12922 active breakpoints are shown with @samp{*} markers.
12923
12924 @item assembly
12925 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
12926
12927 @item register
12928 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
12929 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
12930 changed are highlighted.
12931
12932 @end table
12933
12934 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
12935 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
12936 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
12937 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
12938 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
12939 The following layouts are available:
12940
12941 @itemize @bullet
12942 @item
12943 source
12944
12945 @item
12946 assembly
12947
12948 @item
12949 source and assembly
12950
12951 @item
12952 source and registers
12953
12954 @item
12955 assembly and registers
12956
12957 @end itemize
12958
12959 @node TUI Keys
12960 @section TUI Key Bindings
12961 @cindex TUI key bindings
12962
12963 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
12964 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
12965 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
12966 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The following key bindings
12967 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
12968
12969 @table @kbd
12970 @kindex C-x C-a
12971 @item C-x C-a
12972 @kindex C-x a
12973 @itemx C-x a
12974 @kindex C-x A
12975 @itemx C-x A
12976 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
12977 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
12978 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
12979 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
12980 The screen is then refreshed.
12981
12982 @kindex C-x 1
12983 @item C-x 1
12984 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
12985 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
12986 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
12987
12988 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
12989
12990 @kindex C-x 2
12991 @item C-x 2
12992 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
12993 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
12994 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
12995 previous layout and the new one.
12996
12997 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
12998
12999 @end table
13000
13001 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
13002
13003 @table @key
13004 @kindex PgUp
13005 @item PgUp
13006 Scroll the active window one page up.
13007
13008 @kindex PgDn
13009 @item PgDn
13010 Scroll the active window one page down.
13011
13012 @kindex Up
13013 @item Up
13014 Scroll the active window one line up.
13015
13016 @kindex Down
13017 @item Down
13018 Scroll the active window one line down.
13019
13020 @kindex Left
13021 @item Left
13022 Scroll the active window one column left.
13023
13024 @kindex Right
13025 @item Right
13026 Scroll the active window one column right.
13027
13028 @kindex C-L
13029 @item C-L
13030 Refresh the screen.
13031
13032 @end table
13033
13034 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13035 for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13036 necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13037 @key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13038
13039 @node TUI Commands
13040 @section TUI specific commands
13041 @cindex TUI commands
13042
13043 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13044 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13045 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13046 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13047 in the TUI mode.
13048
13049 @table @code
13050 @item layout next
13051 @kindex layout next
13052 Display the next layout.
13053
13054 @item layout prev
13055 @kindex layout prev
13056 Display the previous layout.
13057
13058 @item layout src
13059 @kindex layout src
13060 Display the source window only.
13061
13062 @item layout asm
13063 @kindex layout asm
13064 Display the assembly window only.
13065
13066 @item layout split
13067 @kindex layout split
13068 Display the source and assembly window.
13069
13070 @item layout regs
13071 @kindex layout regs
13072 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13073
13074 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13075 @kindex focus
13076 Set the focus to the named window.
13077 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13078 can be affected to another window.
13079
13080 @item refresh
13081 @kindex refresh
13082 Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
13083
13084 @item update
13085 @kindex update
13086 Update the source window and the current execution point.
13087
13088 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13089 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13090 @kindex winheight
13091 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13092 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13093 decrease it.
13094
13095 @end table
13096
13097 @node TUI Configuration
13098 @section TUI configuration variables
13099 @cindex TUI configuration variables
13100
13101 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13102 appearance of windows on the terminal.
13103
13104 @table @code
13105 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13106 @kindex set tui border-kind
13107 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13108 The possible values are the following:
13109 @table @code
13110 @item space
13111 Use a space character to draw the border.
13112
13113 @item ascii
13114 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
13115
13116 @item acs
13117 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13118 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
13119
13120 @end table
13121
13122 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13123 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
13124 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13125 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13126 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
13127
13128 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13129 @kindex set tui border-mode
13130 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13131 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13132 @table @code
13133 @item normal
13134 Use normal attributes to display the border.
13135
13136 @item standout
13137 Use standout mode.
13138
13139 @item reverse
13140 Use reverse video mode.
13141
13142 @item half
13143 Use half bright mode.
13144
13145 @item half-standout
13146 Use half bright and standout mode.
13147
13148 @item bold
13149 Use extra bright or bold mode.
13150
13151 @item bold-standout
13152 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
13153
13154 @end table
13155
13156 @end table
13157
13158 @node Emacs
13159 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
13160
13161 @cindex Emacs
13162 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13163 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13164 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13165 @value{GDBN}.
13166
13167 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13168 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13169 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13170 created Emacs buffer.
13171 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
13172
13173 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13174 things:
13175
13176 @itemize @bullet
13177 @item
13178 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13179 @end itemize
13180
13181 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13182 and output done by the program you are debugging.
13183
13184 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13185 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13186 in this way.
13187
13188 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13189 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13190 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13191 stop.
13192
13193 @itemize @bullet
13194 @item
13195 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13196 @end itemize
13197
13198 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13199 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13200 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13201 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13202 and the source.
13203
13204 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13205 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
13206
13207 @quotation
13208 @emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13209 current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13210 the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13211 appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13212 environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13213 session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13214 back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13215 avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13216 your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13217 @kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
13218
13219 A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13220 switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13221 @value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13222 @end quotation
13223
13224 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13225 you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13226 several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13227 Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13228
13229 @example
13230 (setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
13231 @end example
13232
13233 @noindent
13234 (preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13235 in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13236 ``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13237
13238 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13239 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
13240
13241 @table @kbd
13242 @item C-h m
13243 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
13244
13245 @item M-s
13246 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13247 update the display window to show the current file and location.
13248
13249 @item M-n
13250 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13251 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13252 to show the current file and location.
13253
13254 @item M-i
13255 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13256 display window accordingly.
13257
13258 @item M-x gdb-nexti
13259 Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13260 display window accordingly.
13261
13262 @item C-c C-f
13263 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13264 @code{finish} command.
13265
13266 @item M-c
13267 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13268 command.
13269
13270 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
13271
13272 @item M-u
13273 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13274 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13275 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
13276
13277 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
13278
13279 @item M-d
13280 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13281 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
13282
13283 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
13284
13285 @item C-x &
13286 Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13287 of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13288 around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13289 then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13290 argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
13291
13292 You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13293 @code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13294 otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13295 inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13296 wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13297 list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13298 formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13299 is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13300 @end table
13301
13302 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13303 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
13304
13305 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13306 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13307 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13308 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13309 frame.
13310
13311 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13312 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13313 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13314 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13315 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13316 to correspond properly with the code.
13317
13318 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13319 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13320 @ignore
13321 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13322 @kindex Epoch
13323 @kindex inspect
13324
13325 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
13326 called the @code{epoch}
13327 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13328 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13329 each value is printed in its own window.
13330 @end ignore
13331
13332 @include annotate.texi
13333 @include gdbmi.texinfo
13334
13335 @node GDB Bugs
13336 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13337 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13338 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
13339
13340 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
13341
13342 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13343 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13344 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13345 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
13346
13347 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13348 information that enables us to fix the bug.
13349
13350 @menu
13351 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13352 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
13353 @end menu
13354
13355 @node Bug Criteria
13356 @section Have you found a bug?
13357 @cindex bug criteria
13358
13359 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
13360
13361 @itemize @bullet
13362 @cindex fatal signal
13363 @cindex debugger crash
13364 @cindex crash of debugger
13365 @item
13366 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13367 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13368
13369 @cindex error on valid input
13370 @item
13371 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13372 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13373 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
13374
13375 @cindex invalid input
13376 @item
13377 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13378 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13379 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13380 for traditional practice''.
13381
13382 @item
13383 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13384 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
13385 @end itemize
13386
13387 @node Bug Reporting
13388 @section How to report bugs
13389 @cindex bug reports
13390 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13391
13392 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13393 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13394 contact that organization first.
13395
13396 You can find contact information for many support companies and
13397 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13398 distribution.
13399 @c should add a web page ref...
13400
13401 In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
13402 @value{GDBN} to this addresses:
13403
13404 @example
13405 bug-gdb@@gnu.org
13406 @end example
13407
13408 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
13409 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
13410 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13411 @samp{bug-gdb}.
13412
13413 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13414 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13415 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13416 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13417 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13418 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13419 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13420 bug reports to the mailing list.
13421
13422 As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
13423
13424 @example
13425 @sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
13426 Free Software Foundation Inc.
13427 59 Temple Place - Suite 330
13428 Boston, MA 02111-1307
13429 USA
13430 @end example
13431
13432 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13433 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13434 fact or leave it out, state it!
13435
13436 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13437 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13438 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13439 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13440 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13441 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13442 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13443 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13444 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
13445
13446 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13447 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13448 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13449 self-contained.
13450
13451 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13452 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13453 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13454 bugs properly.
13455
13456 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
13457
13458 @itemize @bullet
13459 @item
13460 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13461 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13462 version}.
13463
13464 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13465 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
13466
13467 @item
13468 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13469 version number.
13470
13471 @item
13472 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13473 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
13474
13475 @item
13476 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13477 debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13478 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13479 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13480 compilers.
13481
13482 @item
13483 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13484 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13485 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13486 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
13487
13488 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13489 and then we might not encounter the bug.
13490
13491 @item
13492 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13493 reproduce the bug.
13494
13495 @item
13496 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13497 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
13498
13499 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13500 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13501 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13502 a chance to make a mistake.
13503
13504 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13505 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13506 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13507 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13508 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13509 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13510 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13511 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
13512
13513 @item
13514 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13515 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13516 it by context, not by line number.
13517
13518 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13519 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
13520
13521 @end itemize
13522
13523 Here are some things that are not necessary:
13524
13525 @itemize @bullet
13526 @item
13527 A description of the envelope of the bug.
13528
13529 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13530 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13531 changes will not affect it.
13532
13533 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13534 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13535 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13536 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
13537
13538 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13539 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13540 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13541 less time, and so on.
13542
13543 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13544 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
13545
13546 @item
13547 A patch for the bug.
13548
13549 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13550 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13551 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13552 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
13553
13554 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13555 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13556 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13557 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
13558
13559 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13560 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13561 help us to understand.
13562
13563 @item
13564 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
13565
13566 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13567 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13568 @end itemize
13569
13570 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
13571 @c and consists of the two following files:
13572 @c rluser.texinfo
13573 @c inc-hist.texinfo
13574 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13575 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13576 @include rluser.texinfo
13577 @include inc-hist.texinfo
13578
13579
13580 @node Formatting Documentation
13581 @appendix Formatting Documentation
13582
13583 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13584 @cindex reference card
13585 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13586 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13587 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13588 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13589 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13590 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
13591
13592 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13593 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
13594
13595 @example
13596 make refcard.dvi
13597 @end example
13598
13599 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13600 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
13601 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13602 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13603 your @sc{dvi} output program.
13604
13605 @cindex documentation
13606
13607 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13608 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13609 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13610 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13611 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13612 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
13613
13614 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13615 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13616 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13617 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13618 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13619 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13620 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13621 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
13622
13623 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13624 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13625 @code{makeinfo}.
13626
13627 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13628 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13629 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
13630
13631 @example
13632 cd gdb
13633 make gdb.info
13634 @end example
13635
13636 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13637 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13638 Texinfo definitions file.
13639
13640 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13641 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13642 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13643 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13644 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13645 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
13646 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
13647
13648 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13649 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13650 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13651 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
13652 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
13653 directory.
13654
13655 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
13656 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
13657 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
13658 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
13659
13660 @example
13661 make gdb.dvi
13662 @end example
13663
13664 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
13665
13666 @node Installing GDB
13667 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
13668 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
13669 @cindex installation
13670
13671 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
13672 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
13673 build the @code{gdb} program.
13674 @iftex
13675 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
13676 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
13677 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
13678 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
13679 @end iftex
13680
13681 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
13682 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
13683 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
13684
13685 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
13686 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
13687
13688 @table @code
13689 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
13690 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
13691
13692 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
13693 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
13694
13695 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13696 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
13697
13698 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
13699 @sc{gnu} include files
13700
13701 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
13702 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
13703
13704 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
13705 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
13706
13707 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
13708 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
13709
13710 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
13711 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
13712
13713 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
13714 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
13715 @end table
13716
13717 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
13718 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
13719 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
13720
13721 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
13722 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
13723 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
13724 argument.
13725
13726 For example:
13727
13728 @example
13729 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13730 ./configure @var{host}
13731 make
13732 @end example
13733
13734 @noindent
13735 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
13736 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
13737 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
13738 correct value by examining your system.)
13739
13740 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
13741 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
13742 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
13743 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
13744
13745 @need 750
13746 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
13747 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
13748 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
13749
13750 @example
13751 sh configure @var{host}
13752 @end example
13753
13754 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
13755 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
13756 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
13757 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
13758 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
13759
13760 You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
13761 subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
13762 configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
13763
13764 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
13765 the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
13766
13767 @example
13768 @group
13769 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13770 ../configure @var{host}
13771 @end group
13772 @end example
13773
13774 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
13775 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
13776 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
13777 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
13778 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
13779
13780 @menu
13781 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13782 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
13783 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
13784 @end menu
13785
13786 @node Separate Objdir
13787 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13788
13789 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
13790 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
13791 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
13792 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
13793 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
13794 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
13795 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
13796 program specified there.
13797
13798 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
13799 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
13800 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
13801 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
13802 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
13803 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
13804
13805 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
13806 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
13807
13808 @example
13809 @group
13810 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13811 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
13812 cd ../gdb-sun4
13813 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
13814 make
13815 @end group
13816 @end example
13817
13818 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
13819 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
13820 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
13821 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
13822 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
13823 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
13824
13825 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
13826 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
13827 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
13828 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
13829 You specify a cross-debugging target by
13830 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
13831
13832 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
13833 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
13834 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
13835
13836 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
13837 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
13838 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
13839 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
13840 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
13841
13842 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
13843 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
13844 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
13845 with each other.
13846
13847 @node Config Names
13848 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
13849
13850 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
13851 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
13852 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
13853 of information in the following pattern:
13854
13855 @example
13856 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
13857 @end example
13858
13859 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
13860 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
13861 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
13862
13863 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
13864 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
13865 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
13866 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
13867 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
13868 abbreviations---for example:
13869
13870 @smallexample
13871 % sh config.sub i386-linux
13872 i386-pc-linux-gnu
13873 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
13874 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
13875 % sh config.sub hp9k700
13876 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
13877 % sh config.sub sun4
13878 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
13879 % sh config.sub sun3
13880 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
13881 % sh config.sub i986v
13882 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
13883 @end smallexample
13884
13885 @noindent
13886 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
13887 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
13888
13889 @node Configure Options
13890 @section @code{configure} options
13891
13892 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
13893 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
13894 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
13895 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
13896
13897 @example
13898 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
13899 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13900 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13901 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
13902 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
13903 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
13904 @var{host}
13905 @end example
13906
13907 @noindent
13908 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
13909 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
13910 @samp{--}.
13911
13912 @table @code
13913 @item --help
13914 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
13915
13916 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
13917 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
13918 @file{@var{dir}}.
13919
13920 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
13921 Configure the source to install programs under directory
13922 @file{@var{dir}}.
13923
13924 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
13925 @need 2000
13926 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
13927 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
13928 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
13929 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
13930 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
13931 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
13932 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
13933 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
13934 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
13935 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
13936 @var{dirname}.
13937
13938 @item --norecursion
13939 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
13940 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
13941
13942 @item --target=@var{target}
13943 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
13944 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
13945 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
13946
13947 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
13948
13949 @item @var{host} @dots{}
13950 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
13951
13952 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
13953 @end table
13954
13955 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
13956 needed for special purposes only.
13957
13958 @node Maintenance Commands
13959 @appendix Maintenance Commands
13960 @cindex maintenance commands
13961 @cindex internal commands
13962
13963 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
13964 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
13965 These commands are provided here for reference.
13966
13967 @table @code
13968 @kindex maint info breakpoints
13969 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
13970 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
13971 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
13972 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
13973 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
13974 is shown:
13975
13976 @table @code
13977 @item breakpoint
13978 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
13979
13980 @item watchpoint
13981 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
13982
13983 @item longjmp
13984 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
13985 @code{longjmp} calls.
13986
13987 @item longjmp resume
13988 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
13989
13990 @item until
13991 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
13992
13993 @item finish
13994 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
13995
13996 @item shlib events
13997 Shared library events.
13998
13999 @end table
14000
14001 @end table
14002
14003
14004 @node Remote Protocol
14005 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
14006
14007 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
14008 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
14009 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
14010 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
14011
14012 In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
14013 transmitted and received data respectfully.
14014
14015 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
14016 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
14017 @cindex remote serial protocol
14018 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
14019 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
14020 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
14021 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
14022
14023 @example
14024 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14025 @end example
14026 @noindent
14027
14028 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
14029 @noindent
14030 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
14031 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
14032 eight bit unsigned checksum).
14033
14034 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
14035 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
14036
14037 @example
14038 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14039 @end example
14040
14041 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
14042 @noindent
14043 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
14044 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
14045 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
14046
14047 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
14048 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
14049 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
14050 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
14051 retransmission):
14052
14053 @example
14054 <- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14055 -> @code{+}
14056 @end example
14057 @noindent
14058
14059 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
14060 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
14061 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
14062 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
14063
14064 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
14065 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
14066 exceptions).
14067
14068 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
14069 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
14070 HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
14071
14072 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
14073 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
14074 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
14075
14076 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
14077 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
14078 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
14079 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
14080 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
14081 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
14082 value greater than 126 should not be used.
14083
14084 Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
14085 loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
14086 character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
14087
14088 So:
14089 @example
14090 "@code{0* }"
14091 @end example
14092 @noindent
14093 means the same as "0000".
14094
14095 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
14096 error number. That number is not well defined.
14097
14098 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
14099 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
14100 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
14101 on that response.
14102
14103 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
14104 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
14105 optional.
14106
14107 Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
14108 their corresponding response @var{data}:
14109 @page
14110 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
14111 @item Packet
14112 @tab Request
14113 @tab Description
14114
14115 @item extended mode
14116 @tab @code{!}
14117 @tab
14118 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
14119 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
14120 debugged.
14121 @item
14122 @tab reply @samp{OK}
14123 @tab
14124 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
14125
14126 @item last signal
14127 @tab @code{?}
14128 @tab
14129 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
14130 and continue.
14131 @item
14132 @tab reply
14133 @tab see below
14134
14135
14136 @item reserved
14137 @tab @code{a}
14138 @tab Reserved for future use
14139
14140 @item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
14141 @tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
14142 @tab
14143 @item
14144 @tab
14145 @tab
14146 Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
14147 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
14148 See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
14149 @item
14150 @tab reply @code{OK}
14151 @item
14152 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14153
14154 @item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
14155 @tab @code{b}@var{baud}
14156 @tab
14157 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
14158 transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
14159 transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
14160 acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
14161 to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
14162 ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
14163 specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
14164 that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
14165 happened.}
14166
14167 @item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
14168 @tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
14169 @tab
14170 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
14171 breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
14172 @samp{z} packets.}
14173
14174 @item continue
14175 @tab @code{c}@var{addr}
14176 @tab
14177 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14178 current address.
14179 @item
14180 @tab reply
14181 @tab see below
14182
14183 @item continue with signal
14184 @tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
14185 @tab
14186 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
14187 @code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
14188 @item
14189 @tab reply
14190 @tab see below
14191
14192 @item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
14193 @tab @code{d}
14194 @tab
14195 toggle debug flag.
14196
14197 @item detach
14198 @tab @code{D}
14199 @tab
14200 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
14201 @value{GDBN} disconnects.
14202 @item
14203 @tab reply @emph{no response}
14204 @tab
14205 @value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
14206
14207 @item reserved
14208 @tab @code{e}
14209 @tab Reserved for future use
14210
14211 @item reserved
14212 @tab @code{E}
14213 @tab Reserved for future use
14214
14215 @item reserved
14216 @tab @code{f}
14217 @tab Reserved for future use
14218
14219 @item reserved
14220 @tab @code{F}
14221 @tab Reserved for future use
14222
14223 @item read registers
14224 @tab @code{g}
14225 @tab Read general registers.
14226 @item
14227 @tab reply @var{XX...}
14228 @tab
14229 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
14230 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
14231 each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
14232 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
14233 @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
14234 @code{g} packets is specified below.
14235 @item
14236 @tab @code{E}@var{NN}
14237 @tab for an error.
14238
14239 @item write regs
14240 @tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
14241 @tab
14242 See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
14243 @item
14244 @tab reply @code{OK}
14245 @tab for success
14246 @item
14247 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14248 @tab for an error
14249
14250 @item reserved
14251 @tab @code{h}
14252 @tab Reserved for future use
14253
14254 @item set thread
14255 @tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
14256 @tab
14257 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
14258 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
14259 continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
14260 thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
14261 @item
14262 @tab reply @code{OK}
14263 @tab for success
14264 @item
14265 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14266 @tab for an error
14267
14268 @c FIXME: JTC:
14269 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
14270 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
14271 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
14272 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
14273 @c described. For example:
14274 @c
14275 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14276 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
14277 @c otherwise returns current registers.
14278 @c
14279 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14280 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
14281 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
14282
14283 @item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
14284 @tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
14285 @tab
14286 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
14287 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
14288 step starting at that address.
14289
14290 @item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
14291 @tab @code{I}
14292 @tab
14293 See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
14294
14295 @item reserved
14296 @tab @code{j}
14297 @tab Reserved for future use
14298
14299 @item reserved
14300 @tab @code{J}
14301 @tab Reserved for future use
14302
14303 @item kill request
14304 @tab @code{k}
14305 @tab
14306 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
14307 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
14308
14309 @item reserved
14310 @tab @code{l}
14311 @tab Reserved for future use
14312
14313 @item reserved
14314 @tab @code{L}
14315 @tab Reserved for future use
14316
14317 @item read memory
14318 @tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14319 @tab
14320 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
14321 Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
14322 using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
14323 transfer mechanism is needed.}
14324 @item
14325 @tab reply @var{XX...}
14326 @tab
14327 @var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
14328 to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
14329 sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
14330 @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
14331 @item
14332 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14333 @tab @var{NN} is errno
14334
14335 @item write mem
14336 @tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
14337 @tab
14338 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
14339 @var{XX...} is the data.
14340 @item
14341 @tab reply @code{OK}
14342 @tab for success
14343 @item
14344 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14345 @tab
14346 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
14347 written).
14348
14349 @item reserved
14350 @tab @code{n}
14351 @tab Reserved for future use
14352
14353 @item reserved
14354 @tab @code{N}
14355 @tab Reserved for future use
14356
14357 @item reserved
14358 @tab @code{o}
14359 @tab Reserved for future use
14360
14361 @item reserved
14362 @tab @code{O}
14363 @tab Reserved for future use
14364
14365 @item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
14366 @tab @code{p}@var{n...}
14367 @tab
14368 See write register.
14369 @item
14370 @tab return @var{r....}
14371 @tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
14372
14373 @item write reg
14374 @tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
14375 @tab
14376 Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
14377 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
14378 @item
14379 @tab reply @code{OK}
14380 @tab for success
14381 @item
14382 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14383 @tab for an error
14384
14385 @item general query
14386 @tab @code{q}@var{query}
14387 @tab
14388 Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
14389 have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
14390 company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
14391 optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
14392 must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
14393 @item
14394 @tab reply @code{XX...}
14395 @tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
14396 @item
14397 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14398 @tab error reply
14399 @item
14400 @tab reply @samp{}
14401 @tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
14402
14403 @item general set
14404 @tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
14405 @tab
14406 Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
14407 naming conventions.
14408
14409 @item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
14410 @tab @code{r}
14411 @tab
14412 Reset the entire system.
14413
14414 @item remote restart
14415 @tab @code{R}@var{XX}
14416 @tab
14417 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
14418 This packet is only available in extended mode.
14419 @item
14420 @tab
14421 no reply
14422 @tab
14423 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
14424
14425 @item step
14426 @tab @code{s}@var{addr}
14427 @tab
14428 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14429 same address.
14430 @item
14431 @tab reply
14432 @tab see below
14433
14434 @item step with signal
14435 @tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
14436 @tab
14437 Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
14438 @item
14439 @tab reply
14440 @tab see below
14441
14442 @item search
14443 @tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
14444 @tab
14445 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
14446 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
14447 bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
14448
14449 @item thread alive
14450 @tab @code{T}@var{XX}
14451 @tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
14452 @item
14453 @tab reply @code{OK}
14454 @tab thread is still alive
14455 @item
14456 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14457 @tab thread is dead
14458
14459 @item reserved
14460 @tab @code{u}
14461 @tab Reserved for future use
14462
14463 @item reserved
14464 @tab @code{U}
14465 @tab Reserved for future use
14466
14467 @item reserved
14468 @tab @code{v}
14469 @tab Reserved for future use
14470
14471 @item reserved
14472 @tab @code{V}
14473 @tab Reserved for future use
14474
14475 @item reserved
14476 @tab @code{w}
14477 @tab Reserved for future use
14478
14479 @item reserved
14480 @tab @code{W}
14481 @tab Reserved for future use
14482
14483 @item reserved
14484 @tab @code{x}
14485 @tab Reserved for future use
14486
14487 @item write mem (binary)
14488 @tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
14489 @tab
14490 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
14491 binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
14492 escaped using @code{0x7d}.
14493 @item
14494 @tab reply @code{OK}
14495 @tab for success
14496 @item
14497 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14498 @tab for an error
14499
14500 @item reserved
14501 @tab @code{y}
14502 @tab Reserved for future use
14503
14504 @item reserved
14505 @tab @code{Y}
14506 @tab Reserved for future use
14507
14508 @item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14509 @tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14510 @tab
14511 See @samp{Z}.
14512
14513 @item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14514 @tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14515 @tab
14516 @var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
14517 breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
14518 @samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
14519 bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
14520 the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
14521 @var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
14522 potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
14523 implemented in an idempotent way.
14524 @item
14525 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14526 @tab for an error
14527 @item
14528 @tab reply @code{OK}
14529 @tab for success
14530 @item
14531 @tab @samp{}
14532 @tab If not supported.
14533
14534 @item reserved
14535 @tab <other>
14536 @tab Reserved for future use
14537
14538 @end multitable
14539
14540 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
14541 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
14542 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
14543 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
14544 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
14545 conventions is used.
14546
14547 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
14548
14549 @item @code{S}@var{AA}
14550 @tab @var{AA} is the signal number
14551
14552 @item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
14553 @tab
14554 @var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
14555 (hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
14556 by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
14557 thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
14558 starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
14559 @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
14560 extend the protocol.
14561
14562 @item @code{W}@var{AA}
14563 @tab
14564 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
14565 applicable for certains sorts of targets.
14566
14567 @item @code{X}@var{AA}
14568 @tab
14569 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
14570
14571 @item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
14572 @tab
14573 @var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
14574 @var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
14575 @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
14576 this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
14577 spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
14578 debugger.}
14579
14580 @item @code{O}@var{XX...}
14581 @tab
14582 @var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
14583 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
14584 for 'W', 'T', etc.
14585
14586 @end multitable
14587
14588 The following set and query packets have already been defined.
14589
14590 @multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
14591
14592 @item current thread
14593 @tab @code{q}@code{C}
14594 @tab Return the current thread id.
14595 @item
14596 @tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
14597 @tab
14598 Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
14599 @item
14600 @tab reply *
14601 @tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
14602
14603 @item all thread ids
14604 @tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
14605 @item
14606 @tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
14607 @tab
14608 Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
14609 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
14610 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
14611 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
14612 be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
14613 sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
14614 @item
14615 @tab
14616 @tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
14617 @item
14618 @tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
14619 @tab A single thread id
14620 @item
14621 @tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
14622 @tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
14623 @item
14624 @tab reply @code{l}
14625 @tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
14626 @item
14627 @tab
14628 @tab
14629 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
14630 or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
14631 respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
14632 @code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
14633 (lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
14634
14635 @item extra thread info
14636 @tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
14637 @tab
14638 @item
14639 @tab
14640 @tab
14641 Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
14642 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
14643 the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
14644 thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
14645 The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
14646 Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
14647 "Blocked on Mutex".
14648 @item
14649 @tab reply @var{XX...}
14650 @tab
14651 Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
14652 printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
14653 attributes.
14654
14655 @item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
14656 @tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
14657 @tab
14658 @item
14659 @tab
14660 @tab
14661 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
14662 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
14663 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
14664 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
14665 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
14666 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
14667 @item
14668 @tab
14669 @tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
14670 query (see above).
14671 @item
14672 @tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
14673 @tab
14674 @item
14675 @tab
14676 @tab
14677 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
14678 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
14679 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
14680 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
14681 a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
14682 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
14683
14684 @item compute CRC of memory block
14685 @tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14686 @tab
14687 @item
14688 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14689 @tab An error (such as memory fault)
14690 @item
14691 @tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
14692 @tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
14693
14694 @item query sect offs
14695 @tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
14696 @tab
14697 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
14698 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
14699 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
14700 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
14701 @item
14702 @tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
14703
14704 @item thread info request
14705 @tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
14706 @tab
14707 @item
14708 @tab
14709 @tab
14710 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
14711 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
14712 @item
14713 @tab reply *
14714 @tab
14715 See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
14716
14717 @item remote command
14718 @tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
14719 @tab
14720 @item
14721 @tab
14722 @tab
14723 @var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
14724 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
14725 Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
14726 number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
14727 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
14728 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
14729 @item
14730 @tab reply @code{OK}
14731 @tab
14732 A command response with no output.
14733 @item
14734 @tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
14735 @tab
14736 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
14737 @item
14738 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14739 @tab
14740 Indicate a badly formed request.
14741
14742 @item
14743 @tab reply @samp{}
14744 @tab
14745 When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
14746
14747 @item symbol lookup
14748 @tab @code{qSymbol::}
14749 @tab
14750 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
14751 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
14752 @item
14753 @tab
14754 @tab
14755 @item
14756 @tab reply @code{OK}
14757 @tab
14758 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
14759 @item
14760 @tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
14761 @tab
14762 @sp 2
14763 @noindent
14764 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
14765 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
14766 @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
14767 message, described below.
14768
14769 @item symbol value
14770 @tab @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
14771 @tab
14772 @sp 1
14773 @noindent
14774 Set the value of SYM_NAME to SYM_VALUE.
14775 @item
14776 @tab
14777 @tab
14778 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value
14779 the target has previously requested.
14780 @item
14781 @tab
14782 @tab
14783 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}.
14784 If @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this
14785 field will be empty.
14786 @item
14787 @tab reply @code{OK}
14788 @tab
14789 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
14790 @item
14791 @tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
14792 @tab
14793 @sp 2
14794 @noindent
14795 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
14796 @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols (if available),
14797 until the target ceases to request them.
14798
14799 @end multitable
14800
14801 The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
14802 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
14803 bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
14804 space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
14805 The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
14806 least-significant.
14807
14808 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
14809
14810 @item MIPS32
14811 @tab
14812 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
14813 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
14814 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
14815
14816 @item MIPS64
14817 @tab
14818 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
14819 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
14820 as @code{MIPS32}.
14821
14822 @end multitable
14823
14824 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
14825 does not get any direct output:
14826
14827 @example
14828 <- @code{R00}
14829 -> @code{+}
14830 @emph{target restarts}
14831 <- @code{?}
14832 -> @code{+}
14833 -> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
14834 <- @code{+}
14835 @end example
14836
14837 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
14838
14839 @example
14840 <- @code{G1445...}
14841 -> @code{+}
14842 <- @code{s}
14843 -> @code{+}
14844 @emph{time passes}
14845 -> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
14846 <- @code{+}
14847 <- @code{g}
14848 -> @code{+}
14849 -> @code{1455...}
14850 <- @code{+}
14851 @end example
14852
14853
14854 @include fdl.texi
14855
14856 @node Index
14857 @unnumbered Index
14858
14859 @printindex cp
14860
14861 @tex
14862 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
14863 % meantime:
14864 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
14865 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
14866 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
14867 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
14868 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
14869 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
14870 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
14871 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
14872 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
14873 \page\colophon
14874 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
14875 @end tex
14876
14877 @bye